]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/mh-e.texi
Merge from emacs--rel--22
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / mh-e.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c
3 @c Note: This document requires makeinfo version 4.6 or greater to build.
4 @c
5 @c %**start of header
6 @setfilename ../../info/mh-e
7 @settitle The MH-E Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @c Version of the software and manual.
11 @set VERSION 8.0.3+CVS
12 @c Edition of the manual. It is either empty for the first edition or
13 @c has the form ", nth Edition" (without the quotes).
14 @set EDITION
15 @set UPDATED 2007-09-25
16 @set UPDATE-MONTH September, 2007
17
18 @c Other variables.
19 @set MH-BOOK-HOME http://rand-mh.sourceforge.net/book/mh
20 @set MH-E-HOME http://mh-e.sourceforge.net/
21
22 @c Copyright
23 @copying
24 This is version @value{VERSION}@value{EDITION} of @cite{The MH-E
25 Manual}, last updated @value{UPDATED}.
26
27 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free
28 Software Foundation, Inc.
29
30 @quotation
31 The MH-E manual is free documentation; you can redistribute it and/or
32 modify it under the terms of either:
33
34 @enumerate a
35 @item
36 the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version
37 published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections,
38 no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
39
40 @item
41 the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
42 Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later version.
43 @end enumerate
44
45 The MH-E manual is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
46 WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
47 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
48 General Public License or GNU Free Documentation License for more
49 details.
50
51 The GNU General Public License and the GNU Free Documentation License
52 appear as appendices to this document. You may also request copies by
53 writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street,
54 Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
55 @end quotation
56 @end copying
57
58 @c Info Directory Entry
59 @dircategory Emacs
60 @direntry
61 * MH-E: (mh-e). Emacs interface to the MH mail system.
62 @end direntry
63
64 @c Title Page
65 @setchapternewpage odd
66 @titlepage
67 @title The MH-E Manual
68 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}@value{EDITION}
69 @subtitle @value{UPDATE-MONTH}
70 @author Bill Wohler
71
72 @c Copyright Page
73 @page
74 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
75 @insertcopying
76 @end titlepage
77
78 @ifnottex
79 @html
80 <!--
81 @end html
82 @node Top, Preface, (dir), (dir)
83 @top The MH-E Manual
84 @html
85 -->
86 @end html
87 @insertcopying
88 @end ifnottex
89
90 @c Table of Contents
91 @contents
92
93 @html
94 <!--
95 @end html
96
97 @menu
98 * Preface:: Preface
99 * Conventions:: GNU Emacs Terms and Conventions
100 * Getting Started:: Getting Started
101 * Tour Through MH-E:: Tour Through MH-E
102 * Using This Manual:: Using This Manual
103 * Incorporating Mail:: Incorporating Mail
104 * Reading Mail:: Reading Mail
105 * Folders:: Organizing Your Mail with Folders
106 * Sending Mail:: Sending Mail
107 * Editing Drafts:: Editing a Draft
108 * Aliases:: Aliases
109 * Identities:: Identities
110 * Speedbar:: The Speedbar
111 * Menu Bar:: The Menu Bar
112 * Tool Bar:: The Tool Bar
113 * Searching:: Searching Through Messages
114 * Threading:: Viewing Message Threads
115 * Limits:: Limiting Display
116 * Sequences:: Using Sequences
117 * Junk:: Dealing With Junk Mail
118 * Miscellaneous:: Miscellaneous Commands, Variables, and Buffers
119 * Scan Line Formats:: Scan Line Formats
120 * Procmail:: Reading Mailing Lists Effectively
121 * Odds and Ends:: Odds and Ends
122 * History:: History of MH-E
123 * GFDL:: GNU Free Documentation License
124 * GPL:: GNU Public License
125 * Key Index:: Key (Character) Index
126 * Command Index:: Command Index
127 * Option Index:: Option (Variable) Index
128 * Concept Index:: Concept Index
129
130 @detailmenu
131 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
132
133 Tour Through MH-E
134
135 * Sending Mail Tour::
136 * Reading Mail Tour::
137 * Processing Mail Tour::
138 * Leaving MH-E::
139 * More About MH-E::
140
141 Using This Manual
142
143 * Options::
144 * Ranges::
145 * Folder Selection::
146
147 Reading Your Mail
148
149 * Viewing::
150 * Viewing Attachments::
151 * HTML::
152 * Digests::
153 * Reading PGP::
154 * Printing::
155 * Files and Pipes::
156 * Navigating::
157 * Miscellaneous Commands and Options::
158
159 Sending Mail
160
161 * Composing::
162 * Replying::
163 * Forwarding::
164 * Redistributing::
165 * Editing Again::
166
167 Editing a Draft
168
169 * Editing Message::
170 * Inserting Letter::
171 * Inserting Messages::
172 * Signature::
173 * Picture::
174 * Adding Attachments::
175 * Sending PGP::
176 * Checking Recipients::
177 * Sending Message::
178 * Killing Draft::
179
180 Odds and Ends
181
182 * Bug Reports::
183 * Mailing Lists::
184 * MH FAQ and Support::
185 * Getting MH-E::
186
187 History of MH-E
188
189 * From Brian Reid::
190 * From Jim Larus::
191 * From Stephen Gildea::
192 * From Bill Wohler::
193
194 @end detailmenu
195 @end menu
196
197 @html
198 -->
199 @end html
200
201 @node Preface, Conventions, Top, Top
202 @unnumbered Preface
203
204 @cindex Emacs
205 @cindex Unix commands, Emacs
206 @cindex preface
207
208 This manual introduces another interface to the MH mail system that is
209 accessible through the GNU Emacs editor, namely, @emph{MH-E}. MH-E is
210 easy to use. I don't assume that you know GNU Emacs or even MH at this
211 point, since I didn't know either of them when I discovered MH-E.
212 However, MH-E was the tip of the iceberg, and I discovered more and
213 more niceties about GNU Emacs and MH@. Now I'm fully hooked on both of
214 them.
215
216 The MH-E package is distributed with GNU Emacs@footnote{Version
217 @value{VERSION} of MH-E will appear in GNU Emacs 22.1. It is supported
218 in GNU Emacs 21, as well as XEmacs 21 (except for versions
219 21.5.9-21.5.16). It is compatible with MH versions 6.8.4 and higher,
220 all versions of nmh, and GNU mailutils 1.0 and higher.}, so you
221 shouldn't have to do anything special to use it. This manual covers
222 MH-E version @value{VERSION}. To help you decide which version you
223 have, see @ref{Getting Started}.
224
225 @findex help-with-tutorial
226 @kindex C-h t
227
228 If you don't already use GNU Emacs but want to learn more, you can
229 read an online tutorial by starting GNU Emacs and typing @kbd{C-h t}
230 (@code{help-with-tutorial}). (To learn about this notation, see
231 @ref{Conventions}.) If you want to take the plunge, consult the
232 @iftex
233 @cite{GNU Emacs Manual},
234 @end iftex
235 @ifinfo
236 @ref{top, , GNU Emacs Manual, emacs, GNU Emacs Manual},
237 @end ifinfo
238 @ifhtml
239 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/,
240 @cite{GNU Emacs Manual}},
241 @end ifhtml
242 from the Free Software Foundation.
243
244 If more information is needed, you can go to the Unix manual pages of
245 the individual MH commands. When the name is not obvious, I'll guide
246 you to a relevant MH manual page that describes the action more fully.
247
248 @cindex @cite{MH & nmh: Email for Users & Programmers}
249 @cindex MH book
250 @cindex info
251 @kindex C-h i
252
253 This manual is available in both Info and online formats. The Info
254 version is distributed with Emacs and can be accessed with the
255 @command{info} command (@samp{info mh-e}) or within Emacs (@kbd{C-h i
256 m mh-e @key{RET}}). The online version is available at
257 @uref{http://mh-e.sourceforge.net/manual/, SourceForge}. Another great
258 online resource is the book @uref{http://www.ics.uci.edu/~mh/book/,
259 @cite{MH & nmh: Email for Users & Programmers}} (also known as
260 @dfn{the MH book}).
261
262 I hope you enjoy this manual! If you have any comments, or suggestions
263 for this document, please let me know.
264
265 @cindex Bill Wohler
266 @cindex Wohler, Bill
267
268 @noindent
269 Bill Wohler <@i{wohler at newt.com}>@*
270 8 February 1995@*
271 24 February 2006
272
273 @node Conventions, Getting Started, Preface, Top
274 @chapter GNU Emacs Terms and Conventions
275
276 @cindex Emacs
277 @cindex Emacs, conventions
278 @cindex Emacs, terms
279 @cindex Unix commands, Emacs
280 @cindex conventions, Emacs
281 @cindex terms, Emacs
282
283 If you're an experienced Emacs user, you can skip the following
284 conventions and definition of terms and go directly to the next
285 section (@pxref{Getting Started}).
286
287 @cindex Emacs commands
288 @cindex MH commands
289 @cindex Unix commands
290 @cindex commands
291 @cindex commands, MH
292 @cindex commands, Unix
293 @cindex commands, shell
294 @cindex functions
295 @cindex shell commands
296
297 In general, @dfn{functions} in this text refer to Emacs Lisp functions
298 that one would call from within Emacs Lisp programs (for example,
299 @code{(mh-inc-folder)}). On the other hand, @dfn{commands} are those
300 things that are run by the user, such as @kbd{i} or @kbd{M-x
301 mh-inc-folder}. Programs outside of Emacs are specifically called MH
302 commands, shell commands, or Unix commands.
303
304 @cindex conventions, key names
305 @cindex key names
306
307 The conventions for key names are as follows:
308
309 @table @kbd
310 @item C-x
311 Hold down the @key{CTRL} (Control) key and press the @kbd{x} key.
312 @c -------------------------
313 @item M-x
314 Hold down the @key{META} or @key{ALT} key and press the @kbd{x} key.
315
316 Since some keyboards don't have a @key{META} key, you can generate
317 @kbd{M-x}, for example, by pressing @key{ESC} (Escape),
318 @emph{releasing it}, and then pressing the @kbd{x} key.
319 @c -------------------------
320 @item @key{RET}
321 Press the @key{RETURN} or @key{ENTER} key. This is normally used to
322 complete a command.
323 @c -------------------------
324 @item @key{SPC}
325 Press the space bar.
326 @c -------------------------
327 @item @key{TAB}
328 Press the @key{TAB} key.
329 @c -------------------------
330 @item @key{DEL}
331 Press the @key{DELETE} key.
332 @c -------------------------
333 @item @key{BS}
334 Press the @key{BACKSPACE} key@footnote{If you are using Version 20 or
335 earlier of Emacs, you will need to use the @key{DEL} key.}.
336 @end table
337
338 @cindex Emacs, prefix argument
339 @cindex prefix argument
340 @kindex C-u
341
342 A @dfn{prefix argument} allows you to pass an argument to any Emacs
343 function. To pass an argument, type @kbd{C-u} before the Emacs command
344 or keystroke. Numeric arguments can be passed as well. For example, to
345 insert five f's, use @kbd{C-u 5 f}. There is a default of four when
346 using @kbd{C-u}, and you can use multiple prefix arguments to provide
347 arguments of powers of four. To continue our example, you could insert
348 four f's with @kbd{C-u f}, 16 f's with @kbd{C-u C-u f}, 64 f's with
349 @kbd{C-u C-u C-u f}, and so on. Numeric and valueless negative
350 arguments can also be inserted with the @key{META} key. Examples
351 include @kbd{M-5} to specify an argument of 5, or @kbd{M--} which
352 specifies a negative argument with no particular value.
353
354 @sp 1
355 @center @strong{NOTE}
356
357 @quotation
358 The prefix @kbd{C-u} or @kbd{M-} is not necessary in MH-E's MH-Folder
359 mode (@pxref{Reading Mail Tour}). In this mode, simply enter the
360 numerical argument before entering the command.
361 @end quotation
362 @sp 1
363
364 @cindex @file{.emacs}
365 @cindex Emacs, variables
366 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
367 @cindex variables
368 @findex setq
369
370 Emacs uses @dfn{variables} to hold values. These can be changed via
371 calls to the function @code{setq} in @file{~/.emacs}.
372
373 @cindex Emacs, options
374 @cindex options
375 @findex customize-group
376 @findex customize-option
377
378 Variables in MH-E that are normally modified by the user are called
379 @dfn{options} and are modified through the customize functions (such
380 as @kbd{M-x customize-option} or @kbd{M-x customize-group}).
381 @ifnothtml
382 @xref{Easy Customization,,,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The
383 GNU Emacs Manual}.
384 @end ifnothtml
385 @ifhtml
386 See section
387 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Easy-Customization.html,
388 Easy Customization} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
389 @end ifhtml
390 @xref{Options}.
391
392 @cindex Emacs, faces
393 @cindex faces
394 @cindex highlighting
395 @findex customize-face
396
397 You can specify various styles for displaying text using @dfn{faces}.
398 MH-E provides a set of faces that you can use to personalize the look
399 of your MH-E buffers. Use the command @kbd{M-x customize-face} to do
400 this.
401 @ifnothtml
402 @xref{Face Customization,,,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The
403 GNU Emacs Manual}.
404 @end ifnothtml
405 @ifhtml
406 See section
407 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Face-Customization.html,
408 Face Customization} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
409 @end ifhtml
410
411 @cindex abnormal hooks
412 @cindex hooks
413 @cindex normal hooks
414 @findex add-hook
415 @findex customize-option
416
417 Commands often offer @dfn{hooks} which enable you to extend or modify
418 the way a command works.
419 @ifnothtml
420 @ref{Hooks, , Hooks, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The GNU
421 Emacs Manual}
422 @end ifnothtml
423 @ifhtml
424 See section
425 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Hooks.html,
426 Hooks} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}
427 @end ifhtml
428 for a description about @dfn{normal hooks} and @dfn{abnormal hooks}.
429 MH-E uses normal hooks in nearly all cases, so you can assume that we
430 are talking about normal hooks unless we explicitly mention that a
431 hook is abnormal. We also follow the conventions described in that
432 section: the name of the abnormal hooks end in @code{-hooks} and all
433 the rest of the MH-E hooks end in @code{-hook}. You can add hooks with
434 either @code{customize-option} or @code{add-hook}.
435
436 @cindex Emacs, mark
437 @cindex Emacs, point
438 @cindex Emacs, region
439 @cindex mark
440 @cindex point
441 @cindex region
442 @kindex C-@@
443 @kindex C-@key{SPC}
444
445 There are several other terms that are used in Emacs that you should
446 know. The @dfn{point} is where the cursor currently is. You can save
447 your current place in the file by setting a @dfn{mark}. This operation
448 is useful in several ways. The mark can be later used when defining a
449 @dfn{region}, which is the text between the point and mark. Many
450 commands operate on regions, such as those for deleting text or
451 filling paragraphs. A mark can be set with @kbd{C-@@} (or
452 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}).
453
454 @cindex completion
455 @cindex Emacs, completion
456 @cindex Emacs, file completion
457 @cindex Emacs, folder completion
458 @cindex Emacs, minibuffer
459 @cindex file completion
460 @cindex folder completion
461 @cindex minibuffer
462 @kindex SPC
463 @kindex TAB
464
465 The @dfn{minibuffer} is the bottom line of the Emacs window, where all
466 prompting and multiple-character input is directed. You can use
467 @dfn{completion} to enter values such as folders. Completion means
468 that Emacs fills in text for you when you type @key{SPC} or @key{TAB}.
469 A second @key{SPC} or @key{TAB} will list all possibilities at that
470 point.
471 @ifnothtml
472 @xref{Completion, , Completion, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
473 @end ifnothtml
474 @ifhtml
475 See the section
476 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Completion.html,
477 Completion} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
478 @end ifhtml
479 Note that @key{SPC} cannot be used for completing filenames and
480 folders.
481
482 @findex help-with-tutorial
483 @kindex C-h t
484 @kindex M-x
485
486 The minibuffer is also where you enter Emacs function names after
487 typing @kbd{M-x}. For example, in the preface, I mentioned that you
488 could obtain help with @kbd{C-h t} (@code{help-with-tutorial}). What
489 this means is that you can get a tutorial by typing either @kbd{C-h t}
490 or @kbd{M-x help-with-tutorial}. In the latter case, you are prompted
491 for @samp{help-with-tutorial} in the minibuffer after typing
492 @kbd{M-x}.
493
494 @cindex ~
495
496 The @samp{~} notation in filenames represents your home directory.
497 This notation is used by many shells including @command{bash},
498 @code{tcsh}, and @command{csh}. It is analogous to the environment
499 variable @samp{$HOME}. For example, @file{~/.emacs} can be written
500 @file{$HOME/.emacs} or using the absolute path as in
501 @file{/home/wohler/.emacs} instead.
502
503 @cindex Emacs, interrupting
504 @cindex Emacs, quitting
505 @cindex interrupting
506 @cindex quitting
507
508 @i{In case of trouble:} Emacs can be interrupted at any time with
509 @kbd{C-g}. For example, if you've started a command that requests that
510 you enter something in the minibuffer, but then you change your mind,
511 type @kbd{C-g} and you'll be back where you started. If you want to
512 exit Emacs entirely, use @kbd{C-x C-c}.
513
514 @node Getting Started, Tour Through MH-E, Conventions, Top
515 @chapter Getting Started
516
517 @cindex MH-E, versions
518 @cindex history
519 @cindex versions of MH-E
520
521 Because there are many old versions of MH-E out there, it is important
522 to know which version you have. I'll be talking about @w{Version 8}
523 which is pretty close to @w{Version 6} and @w{Version 7}. It differs
524 from @w{Version 4} and @w{Version 5} and is vastly different from
525 @w{Version 3}. @xref{History}.
526
527 @findex mh-version
528
529 To determine which version of MH-E that you have, enter @kbd{M-x
530 mh-version @key{RET}}. Hopefully it says that you're running
531 @w{Version @value{VERSION}} which is the latest version as of this
532 printing.
533
534 If your version is much older than this, please consider upgrading.
535 You can have your system administrator upgrade the system-wide
536 version, or you can install your own personal version. It's really
537 quite easy. @xref{Getting MH-E}, for instructions for getting and
538 installing MH-E.
539
540 If the @code{mh-version} command displays @samp{No MH variant
541 detected}@footnote{In very old versions of MH-E, you may get the error
542 message, @samp{Cannot find the commands `inc' and `mhl' and the file
543 `components'} if MH-E can't find MH. In this case, you need to update
544 MH-E, and you may need to install MH too. However, newer versions of
545 MH-E are better at finding MH if it is on your system.}, then you need
546 to install MH or tell MH-E where to find MH.
547
548 @cindex Debian
549 @cindex nmh
550 @cindex GNU mailutils
551
552 If you don't have MH on your system already, you must install a
553 variant of MH. The Debian mh-e package does this for you automatically
554 (@pxref{Getting MH-E}). Most people use
555 @uref{http://www.nongnu.org/nmh/, nmh}, but you may be interested in
556 trying out @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/mailutils/, GNU
557 mailutils}, which supports IMAP. Your GNU/Linux distribution probably
558 has packages for both of these.
559
560 @cindex @command{install-mh}
561 @cindex MH commands, @command{install-mh}
562 @cindex MH book
563
564 If you've never run MH before, you need to run @command{install-mh}
565 from the shell before you continue. This sets up your personal MH
566 environment@footnote{See the section
567 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/../overall/setup.html, Setting Up MH} in the
568 MH book.}. If you don't, you'll be greeted with the error message:
569 @samp{Install MH and run install-mh before running MH-E}. This is all
570 you need to know about MH to use MH-E, but the more you know about MH,
571 the more you can leverage its power. See the
572 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/../, MH book} to learn more about MH.
573
574 @cindex @samp{Path:} MH profile component
575 @cindex MH profile
576 @cindex MH profile component
577 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Path:}
578
579 Your MH environment includes your @dfn{MH profile} which is found in
580 the file @file{~/.mh_profile}. This file contains a number of @dfn{MH
581 profile components}. For example, the @samp{Path:} MH profile
582 component contains the path to your mail directory, which is
583 @file{~/Mail} by default.
584
585 @cindex @command{mhparam}
586 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhparam}
587 @vindex exec-path
588 @vindex mh-path
589 @vindex mh-sys-path
590 @vindex mh-variant
591 @vindex mh-variant-in-use
592
593 There are several options MH-E uses to interact with your MH
594 installation. The option @code{mh-variant} specifies the variant used
595 by MH-E (@pxref{Options}). The default setting of this option is
596 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose the
597 first of nmh, MH, or GNU mailutils that it finds in the directories
598 listed in @code{mh-path} (which you can customize),
599 @code{mh-sys-path}, and @code{exec-path}. If MH-E can't find MH at
600 all, you may have to customize @code{mh-path} and add the directory in
601 which the command @command{mhparam} is located. If, on the other hand,
602 you have both nmh and mailutils installed (for example) and
603 @code{mh-variant-in-use} was initialized to nmh but you want to use
604 mailutils, then you can set @code{mh-variant} to @samp{mailutils}.
605
606 @vindex mh-flists-present-flag
607 @vindex mh-lib
608 @vindex mh-lib-progs
609 @vindex mh-progs
610
611 When @code{mh-variant} is changed, MH-E resets @code{mh-progs},
612 @code{mh-lib}, @code{mh-lib-progs}, @code{mh-flists-present-flag}, and
613 @code{mh-variant-in-use} accordingly.
614
615 @cindex @file{.emacs}
616 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
617
618 @sp 1
619 @center @strong{NOTE}
620
621 @quotation
622 Prior to version 8, it was often necessary to set some of these
623 variables in @file{~/.emacs}; now it is no longer necessary and can
624 actually cause problems.
625 @end quotation
626 @sp 1
627
628 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Draft-Folder:}
629 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Path:}
630 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Previous-Sequence:}
631 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
632 @cindex @samp{Draft-Folder:} MH profile component
633 @cindex @samp{Path:} MH profile component
634 @cindex @samp{Previous-Sequence:} MH profile component
635 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
636 @findex mh-find-path
637 @vindex mh-draft-folder
638 @vindex mh-find-path-hook
639 @vindex mh-inbox
640 @vindex mh-previous-seq
641 @vindex mh-unseen-seq
642 @vindex mh-user-path
643
644 In addition to setting variables that point to MH itself, MH-E also
645 sets a handful of variables that point to where you keep your mail.
646 During initialization, the function @code{mh-find-path} sets
647 @code{mh-user-path} from your @samp{Path:} MH profile component (but
648 defaults to @samp{Mail} if one isn't present), @code{mh-draft-folder}
649 from @samp{Draft-Folder:}, @code{mh-unseen-seq} from
650 @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}, @code{mh-previous-seq} from
651 @samp{Previous-Sequence:}, and @code{mh-inbox} from @samp{Inbox:}
652 (defaults to @samp{+inbox}). The hook @code{mh-find-path-hook} is run
653 after these variables have been set. This hook can be used the change
654 the value of these variables if you need to run with different values
655 between MH and MH-E.
656
657 @node Tour Through MH-E, Using This Manual, Getting Started, Top
658 @chapter Tour Through MH-E
659
660 @cindex introduction
661 @cindex tour
662 @cindex tutorial
663
664 This chapter introduces some of the terms you'll need to know and then
665 takes you on a tour of MH-E@footnote{The keys mentioned in these
666 chapters refer to the default key bindings. If you've changed the
667 bindings, refer to the command summaries at the beginning of each
668 chapter for a mapping between default key bindings and function
669 names.}. When you're done, you'll be able to send, read, and file
670 mail, which is all that a lot of people ever do. But if you're the
671 curious or adventurous type, read the rest of the manual to be able to
672 use all the features of MH-E. I suggest you read this chapter first to
673 get the big picture, and then you can read the manual as you wish.
674
675 @menu
676 * Sending Mail Tour::
677 * Reading Mail Tour::
678 * Processing Mail Tour::
679 * Leaving MH-E::
680 * More About MH-E::
681 @end menu
682
683 @node Sending Mail Tour, Reading Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E, Tour Through MH-E
684 @section Sending Mail
685
686 @cindex MH-Letter mode
687 @cindex mode
688 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
689 @cindex sending mail
690 @findex mh-smail
691 @kindex M-x mh-smail
692
693 Let's start our tour by sending ourselves a message which we can later
694 read and process. Enter @kbd{M-x mh-smail} to invoke the MH-E program
695 to send messages. Your message appears in an Emacs buffer whose
696 mode@footnote{A @dfn{mode} changes Emacs to make it easier to edit a
697 particular type of text.} is MH-Letter.
698
699 Enter your login name in the @samp{To:} header field. Press the
700 @key{TAB} twice to move the cursor past the @samp{Cc:} field, since no
701 carbon copies are to be sent, and on to the @samp{Subject:} field.
702 Enter @kbd{Test} or anything else that comes to mind.
703
704 Press @key{TAB} again to move the cursor to the body of the message.
705 Enter some text, using normal Emacs commands. You should now have
706 something like this@footnote{If you're running Emacs under the X
707 Window System, then you would also see a menu bar and a tool bar. I've
708 left out the menu bar and tool bar in all of the example screens.}:
709
710 @cartouche
711 @smallexample
712
713
714
715
716
717
718 --:-- *scratch* All L1 (Lisp Interaction)-------------------------
719 To: wohler
720 cc:
721 Subject: Test
722 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
723 --------
724 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...#
725
726
727 --:** @{draft@} All L5 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
728 Type C-c C-c to send message, C-C ? for help
729 @end smallexample
730 @end cartouche
731 @i{MH-E message composition window}
732
733 Note the line of dashes that separates the header and the body of the
734 message. It is essential that these dashes (or a blank line) are
735 present or the body of your message will be considered to be part of
736 the header.
737
738 @cindex help
739 @findex describe-mode
740 @kindex C-c ?
741 @kindex C-c C-c
742 @kindex C-h m
743
744 There are several commands specific to MH-Letter mode@footnote{You can
745 get quick help for the commands used most often with @kbd{C-c ?} or
746 more complete help with the @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode})
747 command.}, but at this time we'll only use @kbd{C-c C-c} to send your
748 message. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} now. That's all there is to it!
749
750 @node Reading Mail Tour, Processing Mail Tour, Sending Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
751 @section Receiving Mail
752
753 @cindex @command{inc}
754 @cindex @command{scan}
755 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
756 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
757 @cindex MH-Folder mode
758 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
759 @cindex reading mail
760 @findex mh-rmail
761 @kindex M-x mh-rmail
762
763 To read the mail you've just sent yourself, enter @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}.
764 This incorporates the new mail and puts the output from
765 @command{inc}@footnote{See the section
766 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
767 prev} in the MH book.} (called @dfn{scan lines} after the MH program
768 @command{scan}@footnote{See the section
769 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/faswsprs.html, Find and Specify with scan
770 pick Ranges Sequences} in the MH book.} which prints a one-line
771 summary of each message) into a buffer called @samp{+inbox} whose
772 major mode is MH-Folder.
773
774 @findex mh-rmail
775 @kindex F r
776 @kindex M-x mh-rmail
777
778 @sp 1
779 @center @strong{NOTE}
780
781 @quotation
782
783 The @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} command will show you only new mail, not mail
784 you have already read. If you were to run this tour again, you would
785 use @kbd{F r} to pull all your messages into MH-E.
786 @end quotation
787 @sp 1
788
789 @kindex @key{RET}
790 @kindex n
791 @kindex p
792
793 You should see the scan line for your message, and perhaps others. Use
794 @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to move the cursor to your test message and type
795 @key{RET} to read your message. You should see something like:
796
797 @cartouche
798 @smallexample
799 3 t08/24 root received fax files on Wed Aug 24 11:00:13 PDT 1
800 # 4+t08/24 To:wohler Test<<This is a test message to get the wheels
801
802 -:%% @{+inbox/select@} 4 msgs (1-4) Bot L4 (MH-Folder Show)---------
803 To: wohler
804 Subject: Test
805 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
806 Date: Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800
807 From: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
808
809 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...
810
811
812
813 --:-- @{show-+inbox@} 4 All L1 (MH-Show)----------------------------
814
815 @end smallexample
816 @end cartouche
817 @i{After incorporating new messages}
818
819 @kindex @key{DEL}
820 @kindex @key{SPC}
821
822 If you typed a long message, you can view subsequent pages with
823 @key{SPC} and previous pages with @key{DEL}.
824
825 @node Processing Mail Tour, Leaving MH-E, Reading Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
826 @section Processing Mail
827
828 @cindex processing mail
829 @kindex @key{RET}
830 @kindex r
831
832 The first thing we want to do is reply to the message that we sent
833 ourselves. Ensure that the cursor is still on the same line as your
834 test message and type @kbd{r}. You are prompted in the minibuffer with
835 @samp{Reply to whom:}. Here MH-E is asking whether you'd like to reply
836 to the original sender only, to the sender and primary recipients, or
837 to the sender and all recipients. You can press @key{TAB} to see these
838 choices. If you simply press @key{RET}, you'll reply only to the
839 sender. Press @key{RET} now.
840
841 You'll find yourself in an Emacs buffer similar to that when you were
842 sending the original message, like this:
843
844 @cartouche
845 @smallexample
846 To:
847 cc:
848 Subject: Re: Test
849 In-reply-to: <31054.1142621351@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
850 References: <31054.1142621351@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
851 Comments: In-reply-to Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
852 message dated "Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800."
853 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
854 --------
855 #
856
857 --:-- @{draft@} All L10 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
858 To: wohler
859 Subject: Test
860 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
861 Date: Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800
862 From: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
863
864 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...
865
866 --:-- @{show-+inbox@} 4 All L1 (MH-Show)----------------------------
867 Type C-c C-c to send message, C-c ? for help
868 @end smallexample
869 @end cartouche
870 @i{Composition window during reply}
871
872 @findex backward-char
873 @findex forward-char
874 @findex next-line
875 @findex previous-line
876 @kindex C-b
877 @kindex C-c C-c
878 @kindex C-c C-f C-t
879 @kindex C-f
880 @kindex C-n
881 @kindex C-p
882 @kindex @key{BS}
883
884 By default, MH will not add you to the address list of your replies,
885 so if you find that the @samp{To:} header field is missing, don't
886 worry. In this case, type @kbd{C-c C-f C-t} to create and go to the
887 @samp{To:} field, where you can type your login name again. You can
888 move around with the arrow keys or with @kbd{C-p}
889 (@code{previous-line}), @kbd{C-n} (@code{next-line}), @kbd{C-b}
890 (@code{backward-char}), and @kbd{C-f} (@code{forward-char}) and can
891 delete the previous character with @key{BS}. When you're finished
892 editing your message, send it with @kbd{C-c C-c} as before.
893
894 @cindex @command{refile}
895 @cindex MH commands, @command{refile}
896 @cindex folders
897 @kindex @key{SPC}
898 @kindex o
899
900 You'll often want to save messages that were sent to you in an
901 organized fashion. This is done with @dfn{folders}. You can use
902 folders to keep messages from your friends, or messages related to a
903 particular topic. With your cursor in the MH-Folder buffer and
904 positioned on the message you sent to yourself, type @kbd{o} to output
905 (@command{refile} in MH parlance) that message to a folder. Enter
906 @kbd{test} at the @samp{Destination folder:} prompt and type @kbd{y}
907 (or @key{SPC}) when MH-E asks to create the folder @samp{+test}. Note
908 that a @samp{^} (caret) appears next to the message number, which
909 means that the message has been marked for refiling but has not yet
910 been refiled. We'll talk about how the refile is actually carried out
911 in a moment.
912
913 @cindex MH-Folder mode
914 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
915 @kindex d
916 @kindex i
917 @kindex @key{RET}
918 @kindex n
919 @kindex p
920 @kindex x
921
922 Your previous reply is now waiting in the system mailbox. You
923 incorporate this mail into your MH-Folder buffer named @samp{+inbox}
924 with the @kbd{i} command. Do this now. After the mail is incorporated,
925 use @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to move the cursor to the new message, and read
926 it with @key{RET}. Let's delete this message by typing @kbd{d}. Note
927 that a @samp{D} appears next to the message number. This means that
928 the message is marked for deletion but is not yet deleted. To perform
929 the deletion (and the refile we did previously), use the @kbd{x}
930 command.
931
932 @findex mh-smail
933 @kindex m
934 @kindex M-x mh-smail
935
936 If you want to send another message you can use @kbd{m} instead of
937 @kbd{M-x mh-smail}. So go ahead, send some mail to your friends!
938
939 @cindex help
940 @cindex prefix characters
941 @findex describe-mode
942 @kindex ?
943 @kindex C-h m
944 @kindex F ?
945
946 You can get a quick reminder about these commands by typing @kbd{?}.
947 This lists several @dfn{prefix characters}. To list the commands
948 available via the prefix characters, type the prefix character
949 followed by a @kbd{?}, for example, @kbd{F ?}. More complete help is
950 available with the @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode}) command.
951
952 @node Leaving MH-E, More About MH-E, Processing Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
953 @section Leaving MH-E
954
955 @cindex Emacs, quitting
956 @cindex quitting
957 @kindex C-x C-c
958 @kindex x
959
960 You may now wish to exit @command{emacs} entirely. Use @kbd{C-x C-c}
961 to exit @command{emacs}. If you exited without running @kbd{x} in the
962 @samp{+inbox} buffer, Emacs will offer to save it for you. Type
963 @kbd{y} or @key{SPC} to save @samp{+inbox} changes, which means to
964 perform any refiles and deletes that you did there.
965
966 @findex mh-rmail
967 @kindex C-x b
968 @kindex C-x k
969 @kindex M-x mh-rmail
970 @kindex q
971
972 If you don't want to leave Emacs, you can type @kbd{q} to bury (hide)
973 the MH-E folder or delete it entirely with @kbd{C-x k}. You can then
974 later recall it with @kbd{C-x b} or @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}.
975
976 @cindex @command{packf}
977 @cindex MH commands, @command{packf}
978 @cindex exporting folders
979 @cindex folders, exporting
980 @cindex mbox-style folder
981
982 On the other hand, if you no longer want to use MH and MH-E, you can
983 take your mail with you. You can copy all of your mail into a single
984 file, mbox-style, by using the MH command @command{packf}. For
985 example, to create a file called @file{msgbox} with the messages in
986 your @samp{+inbox} folder, use @samp{packf +inbox}. The
987 @command{packf} command will append the messages to the file if it
988 already exists, so you can use @samp{folders -recurse -fast} in a
989 script to copy all of your messages into a single file, or using the
990 @samp{-file} argument, a file for each folder.
991
992 @node More About MH-E, , Leaving MH-E, Tour Through MH-E
993 @section More About MH-E
994
995 These are the basic commands to get you going, but there are plenty
996 more. If you think that MH-E is for you, read the rest of the manual
997 to find out how you can:
998
999 @itemize @bullet
1000 @item
1001 Print your messages (@pxref{Printing}).
1002 @c -------------------------
1003 @item
1004 Edit messages and include your signature (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
1005 @c -------------------------
1006 @item
1007 Forward messages (@pxref{Forwarding}).
1008 @c -------------------------
1009 @item
1010 Read digests (@pxref{Digests}).
1011 @c -------------------------
1012 @item
1013 Edit bounced messages (@pxref{Editing Again}).
1014 @c -------------------------
1015 @item
1016 Send multimedia messages (@pxref{Adding Attachments}).
1017 @c -------------------------
1018 @item
1019 Read HTML messages (@pxref{HTML}).
1020 @c -------------------------
1021 @item
1022 Use aliases and identities (see @ref{Aliases}, @pxref{Identities}).
1023 @c -------------------------
1024 @item
1025 Create different views of your mail (see @ref{Threading}, @pxref{Limits}).
1026 @c -------------------------
1027 @item
1028 Deal with junk mail (@pxref{Junk}).
1029 @c -------------------------
1030 @item
1031 Handle signed and encrypted messages (see @ref{Reading PGP},
1032 @pxref{Sending PGP}).
1033 @c -------------------------
1034 @item
1035 Process mail that was sent with @command{shar} or @command{uuencode}
1036 (@pxref{Files and Pipes}).
1037 @c -------------------------
1038 @item
1039 Use sequences conveniently (@pxref{Sequences}).
1040 @c -------------------------
1041 @item
1042 Use the speedbar, tool bar, and menu bar (see @ref{Speedbar}, see @ref{Tool
1043 Bar}, @pxref{Menu Bar}).
1044 @c -------------------------
1045 @item
1046 Show header fields in different fonts (@pxref{Reading Mail}).
1047 @c -------------------------
1048 @item
1049 Find previously refiled messages (@pxref{Searching}).
1050 @c -------------------------
1051 @item
1052 Place messages in a file (@pxref{Files and Pipes}).
1053 @end itemize
1054
1055 Remember that you can also use MH commands when you're not running
1056 MH-E (and when you are!).
1057
1058 @node Using This Manual, Incorporating Mail, Tour Through MH-E, Top
1059 @chapter Using This Manual
1060
1061 This chapter begins the meat of the manual which goes into more detail
1062 about every MH-E command and option.
1063
1064 @cindex Emacs, info
1065 @cindex Emacs, online help
1066 @cindex info
1067 @cindex online help
1068 @findex describe-mode
1069 @findex mh-help
1070 @kindex ?
1071 @kindex C-c ?
1072 @kindex C-h C-h
1073 @kindex C-h C-k i
1074 @kindex C-h i
1075 @kindex C-h m
1076
1077 There are many commands, but don't get intimidated. There are command
1078 summaries at the beginning of each chapter. In case you have or would
1079 like to rebind the keys, the command summaries also list the
1080 associated Emacs Lisp function. Furthermore, even if you're stranded
1081 on a desert island with a laptop and are without your manuals, you can
1082 get a summary of all these commands with GNU Emacs online help: use
1083 @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode}) for a brief summary of commands,
1084 @kbd{?} (@code{mh-help}) for an even briefer summary@footnote{This
1085 help appears in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Help*}
1086 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).} (@kbd{C-c ?} in MH-Letter mode), or @kbd{C-h
1087 i} to read this manual via Info. The online help is quite good; try
1088 running @kbd{C-h C-h}. This brings up a list of available help topics,
1089 one of which displays the documentation for a given key (like @kbd{C-h
1090 k C-n}). Another useful help feature is to view the manual section
1091 that describes a given key (such as @kbd{C-h K i}). In addition,
1092 review @ref{Conventions}, if any of the GNU Emacs conventions are
1093 strange to you.
1094
1095 In addition to all of the commands, it is also possible to reconfigure
1096 MH-E to fit the needs of even the most demanding user. The following
1097 chapters also describe all of the options, show the defaults, and make
1098 recommendations for customization.
1099
1100 However, when customizing your mail environment, first try to change
1101 what you want in MH, and only change MH-E if changing MH is not
1102 possible. That way you will get the same behavior inside and outside
1103 GNU Emacs. Note that MH-E does not provide hooks for customizations
1104 that can be done in MH; this omission is intentional.
1105
1106 @cindex Emacs Lisp Manual
1107 @cindex Emacs, Emacs Lisp Manual
1108 @cindex Emacs, info
1109 @cindex Emacs, online help
1110 @cindex info
1111 @cindex online help
1112
1113 I hope I've included enough examples here to get you well on your way.
1114 If you want to explore Emacs Lisp further, a programming manual does
1115 exist,
1116 @c Yes, some of the stuff in the following sections is redundant, but
1117 @c TeX barfs if the @ifs are inside the @footnote.
1118 @iftex
1119 @footnote{The @cite{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual} may be available
1120 online in the Info system by typing @kbd{C-h i m Emacs Lisp
1121 @key{RET}}. It is also available online at @*
1122 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/}. You
1123 can also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect
1124 of helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1125 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1126 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1127 gnu.org}.}
1128 @end iftex
1129 @ifinfo
1130 @footnote{@xref{Top, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual, , elisp, GNU
1131 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, which may be available online in the
1132 Info system. It is also available online at
1133 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/}. You
1134 can also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect
1135 of helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1136 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1137 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1138 gnu.org}.}
1139 @end ifinfo
1140 @ifhtml
1141 @footnote{The
1142 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/,
1143 The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual} may also be available online in
1144 the Info system by typing @kbd{C-h i m Emacs Lisp @key{RET}}. You can
1145 also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect of
1146 helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1147 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1148 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1149 gnu.org}.}
1150 @end ifhtml
1151 and you can look at the code itself for examples. Look in the Emacs
1152 Lisp directory on your system (such as
1153 @file{/usr/local/lib/emacs/lisp/mh-e}) and find all the @file{mh-*.el}
1154 files there. When calling MH-E and other Emacs Lisp functions directly
1155 from Emacs Lisp code, you'll need to know the correct arguments. Use
1156 the online help for this. For example, try @kbd{C-h f
1157 mh-execute-commands @key{RET}}. If you write your own functions,
1158 please do not prefix your symbols (variables and functions) with
1159 @samp{mh-}. This prefix is reserved for the MH-E package. To avoid
1160 conflicts with existing MH-E symbols, use a prefix like @samp{my-} or
1161 your initials. (Unless, of course, your initials happen to be @emph{mh}!)
1162
1163 @menu
1164 * Options::
1165 * Ranges::
1166 * Folder Selection::
1167 @end menu
1168
1169 @node Options, Ranges, Using This Manual, Using This Manual
1170 @section Options
1171
1172 @cindex Emacs, customizing
1173 @cindex Emacs, setting options
1174 @cindex customizing MH-E
1175 @cindex setting options
1176 @findex customize-option
1177 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format, example
1178
1179 Many string or integer options are easy to modify using @kbd{M-x
1180 customize-option}. For example, to modify the option that controls
1181 printing, you would run @kbd{M-x customize-option @key{RET}
1182 mh-lpr-command-format @key{RET}}. In the buffer that appears, modify
1183 the string to the right of the variable. For example, you may change
1184 the @command{lpr} command with @samp{nenscript -G -r -2 -i'%s'}. Then
1185 use the @samp{State} combo box and select @samp{Save for Future
1186 Sessions}. To read more about @code{mh-lpr-command-format}, see
1187 @ref{Printing}.
1188
1189 @cindex nil
1190 @cindex off, option
1191 @cindex on, option
1192 @cindex option, turning on and off
1193 @cindex t
1194 @findex customize-option
1195 @vindex mh-bury-show-buffer-flag, example
1196
1197 Options can also hold boolean values. In Emacs Lisp, the boolean
1198 values are @code{nil}, which means false, and @code{t}, which means
1199 true. The @code{customize-option} function makes it easy to change
1200 boolean values; simply click on the toggle button in the customize
1201 buffer to switch between @samp{on} (@code{t}) and @samp{off}
1202 (@code{nil}). For example, try setting @code{mh-bury-show-buffer-flag}
1203 to @samp{off} to keep the MH-Show buffer at the top of the buffer
1204 stack. Use the @samp{State} combo box and choose @samp{Set for Current
1205 Session} to see how the option affects the show buffer. Then choose
1206 the @samp{Erase Customization} menu item to reset the option to the
1207 default, which places the MH-Show buffer at the bottom of the buffer
1208 stack.
1209
1210 @vindex mh-mhl-format-file, example
1211
1212 The text usually says to turn on an option by setting it to a
1213 @emph{non-@code{nil}} value, because sometimes values other than
1214 @samp{on} are meaningful. An example of this is the variable
1215 @code{mh-mhl-format-file} (@pxref{Viewing}). Other options, such as
1216 hooks, involve a little more Emacs Lisp programming expertise.
1217
1218 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh}
1219 @cindex @samp{mh} customization group
1220 @findex customize-group
1221 @findex mh-customize
1222
1223 You can browse all of the MH-E options with the @code{customize-group}
1224 function. Try entering @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} mh
1225 @key{RET}} to view the top-level options as well as buttons for all of
1226 the MH-E customization groups. Another way to view the MH-E
1227 customization group is to use @kbd{M-x mh-customize @key{RET}}.
1228
1229 @node Ranges, Folder Selection, Options, Using This Manual
1230 @section Ranges
1231
1232 @c Sync with mh-folder-mode docstring.
1233
1234 @cindex message abbreviations
1235 @cindex message ranges
1236 @cindex ranges
1237
1238 Many commands that operate on individual messages, such as
1239 @code{mh-forward} or @code{mh-refile-msg} take a @code{RANGE}
1240 argument. This argument can be used in several ways.
1241
1242 @kindex C-u, with ranges
1243
1244 If you provide the prefix argument @kbd{C-u} to these commands, then
1245 you will be prompted for the message range. This can be any valid MH
1246 range which can include messages, sequences (@pxref{Sequences}), and
1247 the abbreviations (described in the @command{mh}(1) man page):
1248
1249 @table @samp
1250 @item <num1>-<num2>
1251 Indicates all messages in the range <num1> to <num2>, inclusive. The
1252 range must be nonempty.
1253 @c -------------------------
1254 @item <num>:N
1255 @itemx <num>:+N
1256 @itemx <num>:-N
1257 Up to N messages beginning with (or ending with) message num. Num may
1258 be any of the predefined symbols: first, prev, cur, next or last.
1259 @c -------------------------
1260 @item first:N
1261 @itemx prev:N
1262 @itemx next:N
1263 @itemx last:N
1264 The first, previous, next or last messages, if they exist.
1265 @c -------------------------
1266 @item all
1267 All of the messages.
1268 @end table
1269
1270 For example, a range that shows all of these things is @samp{1 2 3
1271 5-10 last:5 unseen}.
1272
1273 @vindex transient-mark-mode
1274
1275 If the option @code{transient-mark-mode} is turned on and you set a
1276 region in the MH-Folder buffer, then the MH-E command will perform the
1277 operation on all messages in that region.
1278
1279 @cindex @samp{mh-range} customization group
1280 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-range}
1281
1282 The @samp{mh-range} customization group contains a single option which
1283 affects how ranges are interpreted.
1284
1285 @vtable @code
1286 @item mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag
1287 On means interpret a number as a range (default: @samp{on}).
1288 @end vtable
1289
1290 @vindex mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag
1291
1292 Since one of the most frequent ranges used is @samp{last:N}, MH-E will
1293 interpret input such as @samp{200} as @samp{last:200} if the
1294 @code{mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag} option is on (which is the
1295 default). If you need to scan just the message 200, then use the range
1296 @samp{200:1} or @samp{200-200}.
1297
1298 @node Folder Selection, , Ranges, Using This Manual
1299 @section Folder Selection
1300
1301 @cindex completion, folders
1302 @cindex folders, completion
1303 @cindex folders, selecting
1304
1305 When you choose a folder in MH-E via a command such as @kbd{o}
1306 (@code{mh-refile-msg}), completion is used to enter the folder
1307 @ifnothtml
1308 (@pxref{Completion, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1309 @end ifnothtml
1310 @ifhtml
1311 (see the section
1312 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Completion.html,
1313 Completion} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1314 @end ifhtml
1315 In addition, MH-E has several ways of choosing a suitable default so
1316 that the folder can often be selected with a single @key{RET} key.
1317
1318 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-folder-selection}
1319 @cindex @samp{mh-folder-selection} customization group
1320
1321 The @samp{mh-folder-selection} customization group contains some
1322 options which are used to help with this.
1323
1324 @vtable @code
1325 @item mh-default-folder-for-message-function
1326 Function to select a default folder for refiling or @samp{Fcc:}
1327 (default: @code{nil}).
1328 @c -------------------------
1329 @item mh-default-folder-list
1330 List of addresses and folders (default: @code{nil}).
1331 @c -------------------------
1332 @item mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag
1333 On means guessed folder name must exist to be used (default:
1334 @samp{on}).
1335 @c -------------------------
1336 @item mh-default-folder-prefix
1337 Prefix used for folder names generated from aliases (default: @code{""}).
1338 @end vtable
1339
1340 @vindex mh-default-folder-for-message-function
1341
1342 You can set the option @code{mh-default-folder-for-message-function}
1343 to a function that provides a default folder for the message to be
1344 refiled. When this function is called, the current buffer contains the
1345 message being refiled and point is at the start of the message. This
1346 function should return the default folder as a string with a leading
1347 @samp{+} sign. It can also return @code{nil} so that the last folder
1348 name is used as the default, or an empty string to suppress the
1349 default entirely.
1350
1351 Otherwise, the name of the destination folder is derived from the
1352 sender as follows:
1353
1354 @enumerate
1355 @vindex mh-default-folder-list
1356 @item
1357 The folder name associated with the first address found in the list
1358 @code{mh-default-folder-list} is used. Each element in this list
1359 contains a @samp{Check Recipient} item. If this item is turned on,
1360 then the address is checked against the recipient instead of the
1361 sender. This is useful for mailing lists.
1362 @c -------------------------
1363 @vindex mh-default-folder-prefix
1364 @item
1365 An alias prefixed by @code{mh-default-folder-prefix} corresponding to
1366 the address is used. The prefix is used to prevent clutter in your
1367 mail directory. @xref{Aliases}.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 @vindex mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag
1371
1372 If the derived folder does not exist, and
1373 @code{mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag} is @code{t}, then the last
1374 folder name used is suggested. This is useful if you get mail from
1375 various people for whom you have an alias, but file them all in the
1376 same project folder.
1377
1378 @node Incorporating Mail, Reading Mail, Using This Manual, Top
1379 @chapter Incorporating Your Mail
1380
1381 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
1382 @cindex incorporating
1383 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
1384
1385 This chapter talks about getting mail from your system mailbox into
1386 your MH @samp{+inbox} folder. The following command accomplishes that
1387 and is found in the @samp{Folder} menu.
1388
1389 @table @kbd
1390 @cindex @samp{Folder > Incorporate New Mail} menu item
1391 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Incorporate New Mail}
1392 @findex mh-inc-folder
1393 @kindex i
1394 @item i
1395 Incorporate new mail into a folder (@code{mh-inc-folder}).
1396 @end table
1397
1398 @cindex @samp{mh-inc} customization group
1399 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-inc}
1400
1401 The following options in the @samp{mh-inc} customization group are
1402 used.
1403
1404 @vtable @code
1405 @item mh-inc-prog
1406 Program to incorporate mail (default: @code{"inc"}).
1407 @c -------------------------
1408 @item mh-inc-spool-list
1409 Alternate spool files (default: @code{nil}).
1410 @end vtable
1411
1412 The following hook is available.
1413
1414 @vtable @code
1415 @findex mh-inc-folder
1416 @item mh-inc-folder-hook
1417 Hook run by @code{mh-inc-folder} after incorporating mail into a
1418 folder (default: @code{nil}).
1419 @end vtable
1420
1421 @cindex @samp{+inbox}
1422 @findex mh-inc-folder
1423 @kindex i
1424
1425 If at any time you receive new mail, incorporate the new mail into
1426 your @samp{+inbox} buffer with @kbd{i} (@code{mh-inc-folder}). Note
1427 that @kbd{i} will display the @samp{+inbox} buffer, even if there
1428 isn't any new mail. You can incorporate mail from any file into the
1429 current folder by specifying a prefix argument; you'll be prompted for
1430 the name of the file to use as well as the destination folder (for
1431 example, @kbd{C-u i ~/mbox @key{RET} +tmp @key{RET}}).
1432
1433 @cindex @file{.emacs}
1434 @cindex Emacs, notification of new mail
1435 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
1436 @cindex new mail
1437 @cindex notification of new mail
1438
1439 Emacs can notify you when you have new mail by displaying @samp{Mail}
1440 in the mode line. To enable this behavior, and to have a clock in the
1441 mode line as well, add the following to @file{~/.emacs}:
1442
1443 @findex display-time
1444
1445 @smalllisp
1446 (display-time)
1447 @end smalllisp
1448
1449 @cindex @command{inc}
1450 @cindex incorporating
1451 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
1452 @vindex mh-inc-prog
1453 @vindex mh-progs
1454
1455 The name of the program that incorporates new mail is stored in
1456 @code{mh-inc-prog}; it is @code{"inc"} by default. This program
1457 generates a one-line summary for each of the new messages. Unless it
1458 is an absolute pathname, the file is assumed to be in the
1459 @code{mh-progs} directory (@pxref{Getting Started}). You may also link
1460 a file to @command{inc} that uses a different format (see
1461 @samp{mh-profile}(5), and sections
1462 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
1463 prev} and @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mhstr.html, MH Format Strings} in
1464 the MH book). You'll then need to modify several variables
1465 appropriately (@pxref{Scan Line Formats}).
1466
1467 @vindex mh-inc-spool-list
1468
1469 You can use the @code{mh-inc-spool-list} variable to direct MH-E to
1470 retrieve mail from arbitrary spool files other than your system
1471 mailbox, file it in folders other than your @samp{+inbox}, and assign
1472 key bindings to incorporate this mail.
1473
1474 @cindex @command{procmail}
1475 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
1476 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
1477 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
1478
1479 Suppose you are subscribed to the @i{mh-e-devel} mailing list and you
1480 use @command{procmail} to filter this mail into @file{~/mail/mh-e}
1481 with the following recipe in @file{.procmailrc}:
1482
1483 @smallexample
1484 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
1485 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
1486 :0:
1487 * ^From mh-e-devel-admin@@stop.mail-abuse.org
1488 mh-e
1489 @end smallexample
1490
1491 @findex mh-inc-spool-*
1492 @kindex I *
1493
1494 In order to incorporate @file{~/mail/mh-e} into @samp{+mh-e} with an
1495 @kbd{I m} (@code{mh-inc-spool-mh-e}) command, customize this option,
1496 and click on the @samp{INS} button. Enter a @samp{Spool File} of
1497 @samp{~/mail/mh-e}, a @samp{Folder} of @samp{mh-e}, and a @samp{Key
1498 Binding} of @samp{m}.
1499
1500 @cindex @command{emacsclient}
1501 @cindex @command{gnuclient}
1502 @cindex @command{xbuffy}
1503 @cindex @samp{gnuserv}
1504 @cindex Unix commands, @command{emacsclient}
1505 @cindex Unix commands, @command{gnuclient}
1506 @cindex Unix commands, @command{xbuffy}
1507
1508 You can use @command{xbuffy} to automate the incorporation of this
1509 mail using the Emacs 22 command @command{emacsclient} as follows:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 box ~/mail/mh-e
1513 title mh-e
1514 origMode
1515 polltime 10
1516 headertime 0
1517 command emacsclient --eval '(mh-inc-spool-mh-e)'
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 In XEmacs, the command @command{gnuclient} is used in a similar
1521 fashion.
1522
1523 @findex mh-inc-folder
1524 @kindex i
1525 @vindex mh-inc-folder-hook
1526
1527 You can set the hook @code{mh-inc-folder-hook}, which is called after
1528 new mail is incorporated by the @kbd{i} (@code{mh-inc-folder})
1529 command. A good use of this hook is to rescan the whole folder either
1530 after running @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} the first time or when you've changed
1531 the message numbers from outside of MH-E.
1532
1533 @findex mh-execute-commands
1534 @findex mh-rescan-folder, example
1535 @findex mh-show, example
1536 @vindex mh-inc-folder-hook, example
1537
1538 @smalllisp
1539 @group
1540 (defun my-mh-inc-folder-hook ()
1541 "Hook to rescan folder after incorporating mail."
1542 (if (buffer-modified-p) ; @r{if outstanding refiles and deletes,}
1543 (mh-execute-commands)) ; @r{carry them out}
1544 (mh-rescan-folder) ; @r{synchronize with +inbox}
1545 (mh-show)) ; @r{show the current message}
1546
1547 (add-hook 'mh-inc-folder-hook 'my-mh-inc-folder-hook)
1548
1549 @i{Rescan folder after incorporating new mail via mh-inc-folder-hook}
1550
1551 @end group
1552 @end smalllisp
1553
1554 @node Reading Mail, Folders, Incorporating Mail, Top
1555 @chapter Reading Your Mail
1556
1557 @cindex @samp{+inbox}
1558 @cindex MH-Folder mode
1559 @cindex MH-Show mode
1560 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
1561 @cindex modes, MH-Show
1562 @cindex reading mail
1563 @findex mh-rmail
1564 @kindex F r
1565 @kindex F v
1566 @kindex M-x mh-rmail
1567
1568 The MH-E entry point for reading mail is @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}. This
1569 command incorporates your mail and creates a buffer called
1570 @samp{+inbox} in MH-Folder mode. The command @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} shows
1571 you only new mail, not mail you have already read@footnote{If you want
1572 to see your old mail as well, use @kbd{F r} to pull all your messages
1573 into MH-E. Or, give a prefix argument to @code{mh-rmail} so it will
1574 prompt you for folder to visit like @kbd{F v} (for example, @kbd{C-u
1575 M-x mh-rmail @key{RET} bob @key{RET}}). @xref{Folders}.}.
1576
1577 @findex display-time
1578 @vindex read-mail-command
1579
1580 There are some commands that need to read mail, such as @kbd{Mouse-2}
1581 over the @samp{Mail} button that @code{display-time} adds to the mode
1582 line. You can configure Emacs to have these commands use MH-E by
1583 setting the option @code{read-mail-command} to @samp{mh-rmail}.
1584
1585 @cindex @command{scan}
1586 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
1587 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
1588 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
1589 @cindex scan lines
1590
1591 The @samp{+inbox} buffer contains @dfn{scan lines}, which are one-line
1592 summaries of each incorporated message. You can perform most MH
1593 commands on these messages via one- or two-letter commands in either
1594 the MH-Folder or MH-Show buffers or by using the @samp{Message} menu.
1595 See @command{scan}(1) for a description of the contents of the scan
1596 lines, and see the Figure in @ref{Reading Mail Tour}, for an example.
1597
1598 @table @kbd
1599 @kindex ?
1600 @findex mh-help
1601 @item ?
1602 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
1603 @c -------------------------
1604 @cindex @samp{Message > Show Message} menu item
1605 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Show Message}
1606 @kindex @key{RET}
1607 @findex mh-show
1608 @item @key{RET}
1609 Display message (@code{mh-show}).
1610 @c -------------------------
1611 @cindex @samp{Message > Show Message with Header} menu item
1612 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Show Message with Header}
1613 @kindex , (comma)
1614 @findex mh-header-display
1615 @item , (comma)
1616 Display message with all header fields (@code{mh-header-display}).
1617 @c -------------------------
1618 @kindex ; (semicolon)
1619 @findex mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag
1620 @item ; (semicolon)
1621 Toggle the value of @code{mh-decode-mime-flag}
1622 (@code{mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag}).
1623 @c -------------------------
1624 @kindex @key{SPC}
1625 @findex mh-page-msg
1626 @item @key{SPC}
1627 Display next page in message (@code{mh-page-msg}).
1628 @c -------------------------
1629 @kindex @key{BS}
1630 @findex mh-previous-page
1631 @item @key{BS}
1632 Display previous page in message (@code{mh-previous-page}).
1633 @c -------------------------
1634 @cindex @samp{Message > Write Message to File...} menu item
1635 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Write Message to File...}
1636 @kindex >
1637 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
1638 @item >
1639 Append message to end of file (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}).
1640 @c -------------------------
1641 @cindex @samp{Message > Pipe Message to Command...} menu item
1642 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Pipe Message to Command...}
1643 @kindex |
1644 @findex mh-pipe-msg
1645 @item |
1646 Pipe message through shell command (@code{mh-pipe-msg}).
1647 @c -------------------------
1648 @kindex C-d
1649 @findex mh-delete-msg-no-motion
1650 @item C-d
1651 Delete range, don't move to next message
1652 (@code{mh-delete-msg-no-motion}).
1653 @c -------------------------
1654 @cindex @samp{Message > Delete Message} menu item
1655 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Delete Message}
1656 @kindex d
1657 @findex mh-delete-msg
1658 @item d
1659 Delete range (@code{mh-delete-msg}).
1660 @c -------------------------
1661 @kindex D ?
1662 @findex mh-prefix-help
1663 @item D ?
1664 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1665 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1666 @c -------------------------
1667 @kindex D @key{SPC}
1668 @findex mh-page-digest
1669 @item D @key{SPC}
1670 Display next message in digest (@code{mh-page-digest}).
1671 @c -------------------------
1672 @kindex D @key{BS}
1673 @findex mh-page-digest-backwards
1674 @item D @key{BS}
1675 Display previous message in digest (@code{mh-page-digest-backwards}).
1676 @c -------------------------
1677 @cindex @samp{Message > Burst Digest Message} menu item
1678 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Burst Digest Message}
1679 @kindex D b
1680 @findex mh-burst-digest
1681 @item D b
1682 Break up digest into separate messages (@code{mh-burst-digest}).
1683 @c -------------------------
1684 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to Message by Number...} menu item
1685 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to Message by Number...}
1686 @kindex g
1687 @findex mh-goto-msg
1688 @item g
1689 Go to a message (@code{mh-goto-msg}).
1690 @c -------------------------
1691 @kindex k
1692 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
1693 @item k
1694 Delete messages with same subject or thread
1695 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}).
1696 @c -------------------------
1697 @kindex K ?
1698 @findex mh-prefix-help
1699 @item K ?
1700 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1701 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1702 @c -------------------------
1703 @kindex K @key{TAB}
1704 @findex mh-next-button
1705 @item K @key{TAB}
1706 Go to the next button (@code{mh-next-button}).
1707 @c -------------------------
1708 @kindex K S-@key{TAB}
1709 @findex mh-prev-button
1710 @item K S-@key{TAB}
1711 Go to the previous button (@code{mh-prev-button}).
1712 @c -------------------------
1713 @kindex K a
1714 @findex mh-mime-save-parts
1715 @item K a
1716 Save attachments (@code{mh-mime-save-parts}).
1717 @c -------------------------
1718 @kindex K e
1719 @findex mh-display-with-external-viewer
1720 @item K e
1721 View attachment externally (@code{mh-display-with-external-viewer}).
1722 @c -------------------------
1723 @kindex K i
1724 @findex mh-folder-inline-mime-part
1725 @item K i
1726 Show attachment verbatim (@code{mh-folder-inline-mime-part}).
1727 @c -------------------------
1728 @kindex K o
1729 @findex mh-folder-save-mime-part
1730 @item K o
1731 Save (output) attachment (@code{mh-folder-save-mime-part}).
1732 @c -------------------------
1733 @kindex K t
1734 @findex mh-toggle-mime-buttons
1735 @item K t
1736 Toggle option @code{mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag}
1737 (@code{mh-toggle-mime-buttons}).
1738 @c -------------------------
1739 @kindex K v
1740 @findex mh-folder-toggle-mime-part
1741 @item K v
1742 View attachment (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}).
1743 @c -------------------------
1744 @cindex @samp{Message > Modify Message} menu item
1745 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Modify Message}
1746 @kindex M
1747 @findex mh-modify
1748 @item M
1749 Edit message (@code{mh-modify}).
1750 @c -------------------------
1751 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to First Message} menu item
1752 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to First Message}
1753 @kindex M-<
1754 @findex mh-first-msg
1755 @item M-<
1756 Display first message (@code{mh-first-msg}).
1757 @c -------------------------
1758 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to Last Message} menu item
1759 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to Last Message}
1760 @kindex M->
1761 @findex mh-last-msg
1762 @item M->
1763 Display last message (@code{mh-last-msg}).
1764 @c -------------------------
1765 @kindex M-n
1766 @findex mh-next-unread-msg
1767 @item M-n
1768 Display next unread message (@code{mh-next-unread-msg}).
1769 @c -------------------------
1770 @kindex M-p
1771 @findex mh-previous-unread-msg
1772 @item M-p
1773 Display previous unread message (@code{mh-previous-unread-msg}).
1774 @c -------------------------
1775 @cindex @samp{Message > Next Message} menu item
1776 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Next Message}
1777 @kindex n
1778 @findex mh-next-undeleted-msg
1779 @item n
1780 Display next message (@code{mh-next-undeleted-msg}).
1781 @c -------------------------
1782 @cindex @samp{Message > Previous Message} menu item
1783 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Previous Message}
1784 @kindex p
1785 @findex mh-previous-undeleted-msg
1786 @item p
1787 Display previous message (@code{mh-previous-undeleted-msg}).
1788 @c -------------------------
1789 @kindex P ?
1790 @findex mh-prefix-help
1791 @item P ?
1792 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1793 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1794 @c -------------------------
1795 @kindex P C
1796 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-color
1797 @item P C
1798 Toggle whether color is used in printing messages
1799 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-color}).
1800 @c -------------------------
1801 @kindex P F
1802 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-faces
1803 @item P F
1804 Toggle whether printing is done with faces or not
1805 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-faces}).
1806 @c -------------------------
1807 @kindex P f
1808 @findex mh-ps-print-msg-file
1809 @item P f
1810 Print range to file (@code{mh-ps-print-msg-file}).
1811 @c -------------------------
1812 @cindex @samp{Message > Print Message} menu item
1813 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Print Message}
1814 @kindex P l
1815 @findex mh-print-msg
1816 @item P l
1817 Print range the old fashioned way
1818 (@code{mh-print-msg}).
1819 @c -------------------------
1820 @kindex P p
1821 @findex mh-ps-print-msg
1822 @item P p
1823 Print range (@code{mh-ps-print-msg}).
1824 @c -------------------------
1825 @kindex X ?
1826 @findex mh-prefix-help
1827 @item X ?
1828 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1829 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1830 @c -------------------------
1831 @cindex @samp{Message > Unpack Uuencoded Message...} menu item
1832 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Unpack Uuencoded Message...}
1833 @kindex X s
1834 @kindex X u
1835 @findex mh-store-msg
1836 @item X s
1837 @itemx X u
1838 Unpack message created with @command{uudecode} or @command{shar}
1839 (@code{mh-store-msg}).
1840 @c -------------------------
1841 @kindex Mouse-2
1842 @findex mh-show-mouse
1843 @item Mouse-2
1844 Move point to mouse event and show message (@code{mh-show-mouse}).
1845 @end table
1846
1847 Within the MH-Show buffer, the following command is defined.
1848
1849 @table @kbd
1850 @kindex @key{RET}
1851 @kindex Mouse-1
1852 @kindex Mouse-2
1853 @findex mh-press-button
1854 @item @key{RET}
1855 @itemx Mouse-1
1856 @itemx Mouse-2
1857 View contents of button (@code{mh-press-button}).
1858 @end table
1859
1860 @cindex @samp{mh-show} customization group
1861 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-show}
1862
1863 The following table lists options in the @samp{mh-show} customization
1864 group that are used while reading mail.
1865
1866 @vtable @code
1867 @item mh-bury-show-buffer-flag
1868 On means show buffer is buried (default: @samp{on}).
1869 @c -------------------------
1870 @item mh-clean-message-header-flag
1871 On means remove extraneous header fields (default: @samp{on}).
1872 @c -------------------------
1873 @item mh-decode-mime-flag
1874 On means attachments are handled (default: @samp{on} if the Gnus
1875 @samp{mm-decode} package is present).
1876 @c -------------------------
1877 @item mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag
1878 On means display buttons for all alternative attachments (default:
1879 @samp{off}).
1880 @c -------------------------
1881 @item mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag
1882 On means display buttons for all inline attachments (default:
1883 @samp{off}).
1884 @c -------------------------
1885 @item mh-do-not-confirm-flag
1886 On means non-reversible commands do not prompt for confirmation
1887 (default: @samp{off}).
1888 @c -------------------------
1889 @item mh-fetch-x-image-url
1890 Control fetching of @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field image (default:
1891 @samp{Never Fetch}).
1892 @c -------------------------
1893 @item mh-graphical-smileys-flag
1894 On means graphical smileys are displayed (default: @samp{on}).
1895 @c -------------------------
1896 @item mh-graphical-emphasis-flag
1897 On means graphical emphasis is displayed (default: @samp{on}).
1898 @c -------------------------
1899 @item mh-highlight-citation-style
1900 Style for highlighting citations (default: @samp{Multicolor}).
1901 @c -------------------------
1902 @item mh-invisible-header-fields-default
1903 List of hidden header fields (default: a checklist too long to list
1904 here).
1905 @c -------------------------
1906 @item mh-invisible-header-fields
1907 Additional header fields to hide (default: @code{nil}).
1908 @c -------------------------
1909 @item mh-lpr-command-format
1910 Command used to print (default: @code{"lpr -J '%s'"}).
1911 @c -------------------------
1912 @item mh-max-inline-image-height
1913 Maximum inline image height if @samp{Content-Disposition:} is not
1914 present (default: 0).
1915 @c -------------------------
1916 @item mh-max-inline-image-width
1917 Maximum inline image width if @samp{Content-Disposition:} is not
1918 present(default: 0).
1919 @c -------------------------
1920 @item mh-mhl-format-file
1921 Specifies the format file to pass to the @command{mhl} program
1922 (default: @samp{Use Default mhl Format (Printing Only)}).
1923 @c -------------------------
1924 @item mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
1925 Default directory to use for @kbd{K a}.
1926 @c -------------------------
1927 @item mh-print-background-flag
1928 On means messages should be printed in the background (default:
1929 @samp{off}).
1930 @c -------------------------
1931 @item mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id
1932 Format string to produce @code{mode-line-buffer-identification} for
1933 show buffers (default: @code{" @{show-%s@} %d"}).
1934 @c -------------------------
1935 @item mh-show-maximum-size
1936 Maximum size of message (in bytes) to display automatically (default:
1937 0).
1938 @c -------------------------
1939 @item mh-show-use-xface-flag
1940 On means display face images in MH-Show buffers (default: @samp{on}).
1941 @c -------------------------
1942 @item mh-store-default-directory
1943 Default directory for @kbd{X s} (default: @samp{Current}).
1944 @c -------------------------
1945 @item mh-summary-height
1946 Number of lines in MH-Folder buffer (including the mode line)
1947 (default: depends on size of frame).
1948 @end vtable
1949
1950 The following hooks are available.
1951
1952 @vtable @code
1953 @item mh-delete-msg-hook
1954 Hook run after marking each message for deletion (default: @code{nil}).
1955 @c -------------------------
1956 @item mh-show-hook
1957 Hook run after @key{RET} shows a message (default: @code{nil}).
1958 @c -------------------------
1959 @item mh-show-mode-hook
1960 Hook run upon entry to @code{mh-show-mode} (default: @code{nil}).
1961 @end vtable
1962
1963 The following faces are available.
1964
1965 @vtable @code
1966 @item mh-show-cc
1967 Face used to highlight @samp{cc:} header fields.
1968 @c -------------------------
1969 @item mh-show-date
1970 Face used to highlight @samp{Date:} header fields.
1971 @c -------------------------
1972 @item mh-show-from
1973 Face used to highlight @samp{From:} header fields.
1974 @c -------------------------
1975 @item mh-show-header
1976 Face used to deemphasize less interesting header fields.
1977 @c -------------------------
1978 @item mh-show-pgg-bad
1979 Bad PGG signature face.
1980 @c -------------------------
1981 @item mh-show-pgg-good
1982 Good PGG signature face.
1983 @c -------------------------
1984 @item mh-show-pgg-unknown
1985 Unknown or untrusted PGG signature face.
1986 @c -------------------------
1987 @item mh-show-signature
1988 Signature face.
1989 @c -------------------------
1990 @item mh-show-subject
1991 Face used to highlight @samp{Subject:} header fields.
1992 @c -------------------------
1993 @item mh-show-to
1994 Face used to highlight @samp{To:} header fields.
1995 @c -------------------------
1996 @item mh-show-xface
1997 X-Face image face.
1998 @end vtable
1999
2000 The functions and variables introduced here are explained in more
2001 detail in the following sections.
2002
2003 @menu
2004 * Viewing::
2005 * Viewing Attachments::
2006 * HTML::
2007 * Digests::
2008 * Reading PGP::
2009 * Printing::
2010 * Files and Pipes::
2011 * Navigating::
2012 * Miscellaneous Commands and Options::
2013 @end menu
2014
2015 @node Viewing, Viewing Attachments, Reading Mail, Reading Mail
2016 @section Viewing Your Mail
2017
2018 @findex mh-header-display
2019 @findex mh-page-msg
2020 @findex mh-previous-page
2021 @findex mh-show
2022 @findex mh-show-mouse
2023 @kindex , (comma)
2024 @kindex . (period)
2025 @kindex @key{BS}
2026 @kindex @key{RET}
2027 @kindex @key{SPC}
2028 @kindex Mouse-2
2029
2030 The command @key{RET} (@code{mh-show}) displays the message that the
2031 cursor is on while @kbd{Mouse-2} (@code{mh-show-mouse}) displays the
2032 message that the mouse cursor is on. If the message is already
2033 displayed, it scrolls to the beginning of the message. Use @key{SPC}
2034 (@code{mh-page-msg}) and @key{BS} (@code{mh-previous-page}) to move
2035 forwards and backwards one page at a time through the message. You can
2036 give either of these commands a prefix argument that specifies the
2037 number of lines to scroll (such as @kbd{10 @key{SPC}}). The @key{SPC}
2038 command will also show the next undeleted message if it is used at the
2039 bottom of a message. MH-E normally hides a lot of the superfluous
2040 header fields that mailers add to a message, but if you wish to see
2041 all of them, use the command @kbd{,} (comma;
2042 @code{mh-header-display}).
2043
2044 @vindex mh-show-maximum-size
2045
2046 The option @code{mh-show-maximum-size} provides an opportunity to skip
2047 over large messages which may be slow to load. The default value of 0
2048 means that all message are shown regardless of size.
2049
2050 A litany of options control what displayed messages look like.
2051
2052 @vindex mh-show-cc
2053 @vindex mh-show-date
2054 @vindex mh-show-from
2055 @vindex mh-show-header
2056 @vindex mh-show-subject
2057 @vindex mh-show-to
2058
2059 First, the appearance of the header fields can be modified by
2060 customizing the associated face: @code{mh-show-to}, @code{mh-show-cc},
2061 @code{mh-show-from}, @code{mh-show-date}, and @code{mh-show-subject}.
2062 The face @code{mh-show-header} is used to deemphasize the other, less
2063 interesting, header fields.
2064
2065 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-invisible-header-fields}
2066 @vindex mh-clean-message-header-flag
2067 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields
2068 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields-default
2069
2070 Normally messages are delivered with a handful of uninteresting header
2071 fields. These are hidden by turning on the option
2072 @code{mh-clean-message-header-flag} (which it is by default). The
2073 header fields listed in the option
2074 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields-default} are hidden, although you can
2075 check off any field that you would like to see. Header fields that you
2076 would like to hide that aren't listed can be added to the option
2077 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields} with a couple of caveats. Regular
2078 expressions are not allowed. Unique fields should have a @samp{:}
2079 suffix; otherwise, the element can be used to render invisible an
2080 entire class of fields that start with the same prefix. If you think a
2081 header field should be generally ignored, report a bug (@pxref{Bug
2082 Reports}).
2083
2084 @cindex header field, @samp{Face:}
2085 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Face:}
2086 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Image-URL:}
2087 @cindex @samp{Face:} header field
2088 @cindex @samp{X-Face:} header field
2089 @cindex @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field
2090 @vindex mh-show-use-xface-flag
2091
2092 MH-E can display the content of @samp{Face:}, @samp{X-Face:}, and
2093 @samp{X-Image-URL:} header fields. If any of these fields occur in the
2094 header of your message, the sender's face will appear in the
2095 @samp{From:} header field. If more than one of these fields appear,
2096 then the first field found in the order @samp{Face:}, @samp{X-Face:},
2097 and @samp{X-Image-URL:} will be used. The option
2098 @code{mh-show-use-xface-flag} is used to turn this feature on and off.
2099 This feature will be turned on by default if your system supports it.
2100
2101 The first header field used, if present, is the Gnus-specific
2102 @samp{Face:} field@footnote{The @samp{Face:} field appeared in GNU
2103 Emacs 21 and XEmacs. For more information, see
2104 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/}.}.
2105
2106 @cindex @command{uncompface}
2107 @cindex Emacs, packages, x-face
2108 @cindex Unix commands, @command{uncompface}
2109 @cindex x-face package
2110 @vindex mh-show-xface
2111
2112 Next is the traditional @samp{X-Face:} header field@footnote{The
2113 display of this field requires the
2114 @uref{ftp://ftp.cs.indiana.edu/pub/faces/compface/compface.tar.Z,
2115 @command{uncompface} program}. Recent versions of XEmacs have internal
2116 support for @samp{X-Face:} images. If your version of XEmacs does not,
2117 then you'll need both @command{uncompface} and the
2118 @uref{ftp://ftp.jpl.org/pub/elisp/, @samp{x-face} package}.}. MH-E
2119 renders the foreground and background of the image using the
2120 associated attributes of the face @code{mh-show-xface}.
2121
2122 @cindex @command{convert}
2123 @cindex @command{wget}
2124 @cindex ImageMagick
2125 @cindex Unix commands, @command{convert}
2126 @cindex Unix commands, @command{wget}
2127 @vindex mh-fetch-x-image-url
2128
2129 Finally, MH-E will display images referenced by the
2130 @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field if neither the @samp{Face:} nor the
2131 @samp{X-Face:} fields are present@footnote{The display of the images
2132 requires the @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/wget/wget.html,
2133 @command{wget} program} to fetch the image and the @command{convert}
2134 program from the @uref{http://www.imagemagick.org/, ImageMagick
2135 suite}.}. Of the three header fields this is the most efficient in
2136 terms of network usage since the image doesn't need to be transmitted
2137 with every single mail. The option @code{mh-fetch-x-image-url}
2138 controls the fetching of the @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field image
2139 with the following values:
2140
2141 @table @samp
2142 @item Ask Before Fetching
2143 You are prompted before the image is fetched. MH-E will remember your
2144 reply and will either use the already fetched image the next time the
2145 same URL is encountered or silently skip it if you didn't fetch it the
2146 first time. This is a good setting.
2147 @c -------------------------
2148 @item Never Fetch
2149 Images are never fetched and only displayed if they are already
2150 present in the cache. This is the default.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 There isn't a value of @samp{Always Fetch} for privacy and DOS (denial
2154 of service) reasons. For example, fetching a URL can tip off a spammer
2155 that you've read his email (which is why you shouldn't blindly answer
2156 yes if you've set this option to @samp{Ask Before Fetching}). Someone
2157 may also flood your network and fill your disk drive by sending a
2158 torrent of messages, each specifying a unique URL to a very large
2159 file.
2160
2161 @cindex @file{.mhe-x-image-cache}
2162 @cindex files, @file{.mhe-x-image-cache}
2163
2164 The cache of images is found in the directory
2165 @file{.mhe-x-image-cache} within your MH directory. You can add your
2166 own face to the @samp{From:} field too. @xref{Picture}.
2167
2168 @cindex @command{mhl}
2169 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
2170 @vindex mh-mhl-format-file
2171
2172 Normally MH-E takes care of displaying messages itself (rather than
2173 calling an MH program to do the work). If you'd rather have
2174 @command{mhl} display the message (within MH-E), change the option
2175 @code{mh-mhl-format-file} from its default value of @samp{Use Default
2176 mhl Format (Printing Only)}. You can set this option to @samp{Use
2177 Default mhl Format} to get the same output as you would get if you ran
2178 @command{mhl} from the shell. If you have a format file that you want
2179 MH-E to use, you can set this option to @samp{Specify an mhl Format
2180 File} and enter the name of your format file (@command{mhl}(1) or
2181 section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in
2182 the MH book tells you how to write one). Your format file should
2183 specify a non-zero value for @samp{overflowoffset} to allow MH-E to
2184 parse the header. Note that @command{mhl} is always used for printing
2185 and forwarding; in this case, the value of @code{mh-mhl-format-file}
2186 is consulted if you have specified a format file.
2187
2188 @cindex citations, highlighting
2189 @cindex highlighting citations
2190 @vindex mh-highlight-citation-style
2191
2192 If the sender of the message has cited other messages in his message,
2193 then MH-E will highlight these citations to emphasize the sender's
2194 actual response. The option @code{mh-highlight-citation-style} can be
2195 customized to change the highlighting style. The @samp{Multicolor}
2196 method uses a different color for each indentation while the
2197 @samp{Monotone} method highlights all citations in red. To disable
2198 highlighting of citations entirely, choose @samp{None}.
2199
2200 @cindex URLs, highlighting
2201 @cindex email addresses, highlighting
2202 @cindex highlighting URLs
2203 @cindex highlighting email addresses
2204 @cindex links, following
2205 @findex goto-address-at-point
2206 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
2207 @kindex Mouse-2
2208 @vindex goto-address-highlight-p
2209
2210 Email addresses and URLs in the message are highlighted if the option
2211 @code{goto-address-highlight-p} is on, which it is by default. To view
2212 the web page for a highlighted URL or to send a message using a
2213 highlighted email address, use @kbd{Mouse-2} or @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}
2214 (@code{goto-address-at-point}). @xref{Sending Mail}, to see how to
2215 configure Emacs to send the message using MH-E.
2216
2217 @cindex boldface, showing
2218 @cindex emphasis
2219 @cindex italics, showing
2220 @cindex smileys
2221 @cindex typesetting
2222 @cindex underline, showing
2223 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
2224 @vindex mh-decode-mime-flag
2225 @vindex mh-graphical-emphasis-flag
2226 @vindex mh-graphical-smileys-flag
2227
2228 It is a long standing custom to inject body language using a
2229 cornucopia of punctuation, also known as the @dfn{smileys}. MH-E can
2230 render these as graphical widgets if the option
2231 @code{mh-graphical-smileys-flag} is turned on, which it is by default.
2232 Smileys include patterns such as :-) and ;-). Similarly, a few
2233 typesetting features are indicated in ASCII text with certain
2234 characters. If your terminal supports it, MH-E can render these
2235 typesetting directives naturally if the option
2236 @code{mh-graphical-emphasis-flag} is turned on, which it is by
2237 default. For example, _underline_ will be
2238 @ifhtml
2239 @html
2240 <u>underlined</u>,
2241 @end html
2242 @end ifhtml
2243 @ifnothtml
2244 underlined,
2245 @end ifnothtml
2246 *bold* will appear in @b{bold}, /italics/ will appear in @i{italics},
2247 and so on. See the option @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} for the whole
2248 list. Both of these options are disabled if the option
2249 @code{mh-decode-mime-flag} is turned off. @xref{Viewing Attachments}.
2250
2251 @cindex signature separator
2252 @cindex vCard
2253 @vindex mh-show-signature
2254
2255 MH-E normally renders signatures and vCards in italics so that the
2256 body of the message stands out more. MH-E depends on the presence of
2257 the @dfn{signature separator} (@code{"-- "}) to do this. You can also
2258 customize the face @code{mh-show-signature} so the appearance of the
2259 signature block is more to your liking.
2260
2261 @vindex mh-show-hook
2262 @vindex mh-show-mode-hook
2263
2264 Two hooks can be used to control how messages are displayed. The first
2265 hook, @code{mh-show-mode-hook}, is called early on in the process of
2266 the message display. It is usually used to perform some action on the
2267 message's content. The second hook, @code{mh-show-hook}, is the last
2268 thing called after messages are displayed. It's used to affect the
2269 behavior of MH-E in general or when @code{mh-show-mode-hook} is too
2270 early.
2271
2272 @cindex MH-Show mode
2273 @cindex modes, MH-Show
2274 @vindex mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id
2275
2276 For those who like to modify their mode lines, use
2277 @code{mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id} to modify the mode line in
2278 the MH-Show buffers. Place the two escape strings @samp{%s} and
2279 @samp{%d}, which will display the folder name and the message number,
2280 respectively, somewhere in the string in that order. The default value
2281 of @code{"@{show-%s@} %d"} yields a mode line of
2282
2283 @smallexample
2284 -----@{show-+inbox@} 4 (MH-Show)--Bot--------------------------------
2285 @end smallexample
2286
2287 @node Viewing Attachments, HTML, Viewing, Reading Mail
2288 @section Viewing Attachments
2289
2290 @cindex attachments
2291 @cindex body parts
2292 @cindex @command{mhshow}
2293 @cindex @command{show}
2294 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhshow}
2295 @cindex MH commands, @command{show}
2296 @cindex MIME
2297 @cindex multimedia mail
2298
2299 MH has the ability to display @dfn{@sc{mime}} (Multipurpose Internet
2300 Mail Extensions) messages which are simply messages with additional
2301 @dfn{body parts} or @dfn{attachments}. You can use the MH commands
2302 @command{show}@footnote{See the section
2303 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
2304 prev} in the MH book.} or @command{mhshow}@footnote{See the section
2305 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#ReMIMa, Reading MIME Mail} in
2306 the MH book.} from the shell to read @sc{mime} messages@footnote{You
2307 can call them directly from Emacs if you're running the X Window
2308 System: type @kbd{M-! xterm -e mhshow @var{message-number}}. You can
2309 leave out the @samp{xterm -e} if you use @command{mhlist} or
2310 @command{mhstore}.}.
2311
2312 @cindex Emacs, packages, mm-decode
2313 @cindex mm-decode package
2314 @findex mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag
2315 @kindex ; (semicolon)
2316 @vindex mh-decode-mime-flag
2317
2318 MH-E can handle attachments as well if the Gnus @samp{mm-decode}
2319 package is present. If so, the option @code{mh-decode-mime-flag} will
2320 be on. Otherwise, you'll see the @sc{mime} body parts rather than text
2321 or attachments. There isn't much point in turning off the option
2322 @code{mh-decode-mime-flag}; however, you can inspect it if it appears
2323 that the body parts are not being interpreted correctly or toggle it
2324 with the command @kbd{;} (semicolon;
2325 @code{mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag}) to view the raw message. This
2326 option also controls the display of quoted-printable messages and
2327 other graphical widgets. @xref{Viewing}.
2328
2329 @cindex buttons
2330
2331 Attachments in MH-E are indicated by @dfn{buttons} like this:
2332
2333 @smallexample
2334 [1. image/jpeg; foo.jpg]...
2335 @end smallexample
2336
2337 @findex mh-next-button
2338 @findex mh-press-button
2339 @findex mh-prev-button
2340 @kindex @key{RET}
2341 @kindex K @key{TAB}
2342 @kindex K S-@key{TAB}
2343 @kindex Mouse-1
2344 @kindex Mouse-2
2345
2346 To view the contents of the button, use either @kbd{Mouse-1} or
2347 @kbd{Mouse-2} on the button or @key{RET} (@code{mh-press-button}) when
2348 the cursor is over the button. This command is a toggle so if you use
2349 it again on the same attachment, it is hidden. If Emacs does not know
2350 how to display the attachment, then Emacs offers to save the
2351 attachment in a file. To move the cursor to the next button, use the
2352 command @kbd{K @key{TAB}} (@code{mh-next-button}). If the end of the
2353 buffer is reached then the search wraps over to the start of the
2354 buffer. To move the cursor to the previous button, use the command
2355 @kbd{K S-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-prev-button}). If the beginning of the
2356 buffer is reached then the search wraps over to the end of the buffer.
2357
2358 @cindex attachments, viewing
2359 @cindex viewing attachments
2360 @findex mh-folder-toggle-mime-part
2361 @kindex K v
2362
2363 Another way to view the contents of a button is to use the command
2364 @kbd{K v} (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}). This command displays
2365 (or hides) the attachment associated with the button under the cursor.
2366 If the cursor is not located over a button, then the cursor first
2367 moves to the next button, wrapping to the beginning of the message if
2368 necessary. This command has the advantage over the previous commands
2369 of working from the MH-Folder buffer. You can also provide a numeric
2370 prefix argument (as in @kbd{4 K v}) to view the attachment labeled
2371 with that number. If Emacs does not know how to display the
2372 attachment, then Emacs offers to save the attachment in a file.
2373
2374 @cindex @file{/etc/mailcap}
2375 @cindex files, @file{/etc/mailcap}
2376 @findex mailcap-mime-info
2377 @findex mh-display-with-external-viewer
2378 @kindex K e
2379
2380 If Emacs does not know how to view an attachment, you could save it
2381 into a file and then run some program to open it. It is easier,
2382 however, to launch the program directly from MH-E with the command
2383 @kbd{K e} (@code{mh-display-with-external-viewer}). While you'll most
2384 likely use this to view spreadsheets and documents, it is also useful
2385 to use your browser to view HTML attachments with higher fidelity than
2386 what Emacs can provide. This command displays the attachment
2387 associated with the button under the cursor. If the cursor is not
2388 located over a button, then the cursor first moves to the next button,
2389 wrapping to the beginning of the message if necessary. You can provide
2390 a numeric prefix argument (as in @kbd{4 K e}) to view the attachment
2391 labeled with that number. This command tries to provide a reasonable
2392 default for the viewer by calling the Emacs function
2393 @code{mailcap-mime-info}. This function usually reads the file
2394 @file{/etc/mailcap}.
2395
2396 @cindex attachments, saving
2397 @cindex saving attachments
2398 @findex mh-folder-save-mime-part
2399 @kindex K o
2400
2401 Use the command @kbd{K o} (@code{mh-folder-save-mime-part}) to save
2402 attachments (the mnemonic is ``output''). This command saves the
2403 attachment associated with the button under the cursor. If the cursor
2404 is not located over a button, then the cursor first moves to the next
2405 button, wrapping to the beginning of the message if necessary. You can
2406 also provide a numeric prefix argument (as in @kbd{3 K o}) to save the
2407 attachment labeled with that number. This command prompts you for a
2408 filename and suggests a specific name if it is available.
2409
2410 @cindex @command{mhn}
2411 @cindex @command{mhstore}
2412 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
2413 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhstore}
2414 @findex mh-mime-save-parts
2415 @kindex K a
2416 @vindex mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
2417
2418 You can save all of the attachments at once with the command @kbd{K a}
2419 (@code{mh-mime-save-parts}). The attachments are saved in the
2420 directory specified by the option
2421 @code{mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory} unless you use a prefix
2422 argument (as in @kbd{C-u K a}) in which case you are prompted for the
2423 directory. These directories may be superseded by MH profile
2424 components, since this function calls on @command{mhstore}
2425 (@command{mhn}) to do the work.
2426
2427 @vindex mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
2428
2429 The default value for the option
2430 @code{mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory} is @samp{Prompt Always} so
2431 that you are always prompted for the directory in which to save the
2432 attachments. However, if you usually use the same directory within a
2433 session, then you can set this option to @samp{Prompt the First Time}
2434 to avoid the prompt each time. you can make this directory permanent
2435 by choosing @samp{Directory} and entering the directory's name.
2436
2437 @cindex attachments, inline
2438 @cindex inline attachments
2439 @findex mh-toggle-mime-buttons
2440 @kindex K t
2441 @vindex mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag
2442
2443 The sender can request that attachments should be viewed inline so
2444 that they do not really appear like an attachment at all to the
2445 reader. Most of the time, this is desirable, so by default MH-E
2446 suppresses the buttons for inline attachments. On the other hand, you
2447 may receive code or HTML which the sender has added to his message as
2448 inline attachments so that you can read them in MH-E. In this case, it
2449 is useful to see the buttons so that you know you don't have to cut
2450 and paste the code into a file; you can simply save the attachment. If
2451 you want to make the buttons visible for inline attachments, you can
2452 use the command @kbd{K t} (@code{mh-toggle-mime-buttons}) to toggle
2453 the visibility of these buttons. You can turn on these buttons
2454 permanently by turning on the option
2455 @code{mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag}.
2456
2457 MH-E cannot display all attachments inline however. It can display
2458 text (including @sc{html}) and images.
2459
2460 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Disposition:}
2461 @cindex inline images
2462 @cindex @samp{Content-Disposition:} header field
2463 @vindex mh-max-inline-image-height
2464 @vindex mh-max-inline-image-width
2465
2466 Some older mail programs do not insert the needed
2467 plumbing@footnote{This plumbing is the @samp{Content-Disposition:}
2468 header field.} to tell MH-E whether to display the attachments inline
2469 or not. If this is the case, MH-E will display these images inline if
2470 they are smaller than the window. However, you might want to allow
2471 larger images to be displayed inline. To do this, you can change the
2472 options @code{mh-max-inline-image-width} and
2473 @code{mh-max-inline-image-height} from their default value of zero to
2474 a large number. The size of your screen is a good choice for these
2475 numbers.
2476
2477 @cindex alternatives
2478 @cindex attachments, alternatives
2479 @vindex mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag
2480
2481 Sometimes, a mail program will produce multiple alternatives of an
2482 attachment in increasing degree of faithfulness to the original
2483 content. By default, only the preferred alternative is displayed. If
2484 the option @code{mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag} is on, then
2485 the preferred part is shown inline and buttons are shown for each of
2486 the other alternatives.
2487
2488 @vindex mm-discouraged-alternatives
2489
2490 Many people prefer to see the @samp{text/plain} alternative rather
2491 than the @samp{text/html} alternative. To do this in MH-E, customize
2492 the option @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, and add
2493 @samp{text/html}. The next best alternative, if any, will be shown.
2494
2495 @kindex K i
2496 @findex mh-folder-inline-mime-part
2497
2498 You can view the raw contents of an attachment with the command @kbd{K
2499 i} (@code{mh-folder-inline-mime-part}). This command displays (or
2500 hides) the contents of the attachment associated with the button under
2501 the cursor verbatim. If the cursor is not located over a button, then
2502 the cursor first moves to the next button, wrapping to the beginning
2503 of the message if necessary. You can also provide a numeric prefix
2504 argument (as in @kbd{4 K i}) to view the attachment labeled with that
2505 number.
2506
2507 For additional information on buttons, see
2508 @ifinfo
2509 @ref{Article Buttons,,,gnus}, and @ref{MIME Commands,,,gnus}.
2510 @end ifinfo
2511 @ifnotinfo
2512 the chapters @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_101.html#SEC101,
2513 Article Buttons} and
2514 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_108.html#SEC108, MIME Commands}
2515 in the @cite{The Gnus Manual}.
2516 @end ifnotinfo
2517
2518 @node HTML, Digests, Viewing Attachments, Reading Mail
2519 @section HTML
2520
2521 @cindex HTML
2522 @cindex Gnus
2523
2524 MH-E can display messages that have been sent in HTML@footnote{This
2525 feature depends on a version of Gnus that is at least 5.10.}. The
2526 content of the message will appear in the MH-Show buffer as you would
2527 expect if the entire message is HTML, or there is an inline HTML body
2528 part. However, if there is an HTML body part that is an attachment,
2529 then you'll see a button like this:
2530
2531 @smallexample
2532 [1. text/html; foo.html]...
2533 @end smallexample
2534
2535 To see how to read the contents of this body part, see @ref{Viewing
2536 Attachments}.
2537
2538 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2539
2540 The browser that MH-E uses is determined by the option
2541 @code{mm-text-html-renderer}. The default setting is set automatically
2542 based upon the presence of a known browser on your system. If you wish
2543 to use a different browser, then set this option accordingly. See the
2544 documentation for the browser you use for additional information on
2545 how to use it. In particular, find and disable the option to render
2546 images as this can tip off spammers that the email address they have
2547 used is valid.
2548
2549 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2550
2551 If you're confused about which @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to use,
2552 here's a brief description of each, sorted by popularity, that
2553 includes the results of a quick poll of MH-E users from 2005-12-23.
2554
2555 @table @asis
2556 @cindex browser, @samp{w3m}
2557 @cindex @samp{w3m}
2558 @kindex Mouse-2
2559 @item @samp{w3m} 7
2560 The @samp{w3m} browser requires an external program. It's quick,
2561 produces pretty nice output, and best of all, it's the only browser
2562 that highlights links. These can be clicked with @kbd{Mouse-2} to view
2563 the content of the link in @samp{w3m}. The @samp{w3m} browser handles
2564 tables well and actually respects the table's width parameter (which
2565 can cause text to wrap if the author didn't anticipate that the page
2566 would be viewed in Emacs).
2567 @c -------------------------
2568 @cindex browser, @samp{w3m-standalone}
2569 @cindex @samp{w3m-standalone}
2570 @item @samp{w3m-standalone} 3
2571 This browser, along with @samp{nil} for the external browser, are the
2572 only choices that work without having to download a separate lisp
2573 package or external program. This browser is quick, but does not show
2574 links. It handles simple tables but some tables get rendered much
2575 wider than the Emacs frame. This browser was the only one not to
2576 handle the escape @samp{&ndash;} (it printed a @samp{?}), but it did
2577 render @samp{&reg;}.
2578 @c -------------------------
2579 @cindex browser, @samp{links}
2580 @cindex @samp{links}
2581 @item @samp{links} 1
2582 The @samp{links} browser requires an external program. It's quick, and
2583 produces nicer output than @samp{lynx} on single column mails in
2584 tables. However, it doesn't show links and it doesn't do as nice a job
2585 on multi-column tables as some lines wrap. At least it fits in 80
2586 columns and thus seems better than @samp{w3} and
2587 @samp{w3m-standalone}. Converts escapes such as @samp{&reg;} to (R).
2588 @c -------------------------
2589 @cindex browser, @samp{lynx}
2590 @cindex @samp{lynx}
2591 @item @samp{lynx} 1
2592 The @samp{lynx} browser requires an external program. It's quick and
2593 produces pretty decent output but it doesn't show links. It doesn't
2594 seem to do multi-column tables which makes output much cleaner. It
2595 centers the output and wraps long lines more than most. Handles
2596 @samp{&reg;}.
2597 @c -------------------------
2598 @item @samp{nil} 1
2599 This choice obviously requires an external browser. Like
2600 @samp{w3m-standalone}, it works out of the box. With this setting,
2601 HTML messages have a button for the body part which you can view with
2602 @kbd{K v} (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}).
2603 @c -------------------------
2604 @cindex browser, @samp{w3}
2605 @cindex @samp{w3}
2606 @item @samp{w3} 0
2607 This choice does not require an external program as all of the
2608 rendering is done in lisp. You do need to get the package separately.
2609 This browser is @strong{slow}, and doesn't appear to have been updated
2610 since 2001 and the author hasn't responded to my emails. It displays
2611 unknown tags instead of hiding them, so you get to see all the
2612 Microsoft crap in certain messages. Tends to make multi-column tables
2613 wider than even a full-screen Emacs can handle. Like @samp{w3m}, you
2614 can follow links, but you have to find them first as they are not
2615 highlighted. Performs well on single-column tables and handles escapes
2616 such as @samp{&reg;}.
2617 @c -------------------------
2618 @cindex browser, @samp{html2text}
2619 @cindex @samp{html2text}
2620 @item @samp{html2text} 0
2621 The @samp{html2text} browser requires an external program. I noticed
2622 that it can do some nasty things with simple HTML mails (like filling
2623 the entire message as if it were one paragraph, including signature).
2624 On another message, it displayed half of the HTML tags for some
2625 reason.
2626 @end table
2627
2628 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2629
2630 For a couple more sources of information about
2631 @code{mm-text-html-renderer},
2632 @ifinfo
2633 @xref{Display Customization,,,emacs-mime}, and the documentation for
2634 the Gnus command @kbd{W h} (@pxref{Article Washing,,,gnus},).
2635 @end ifinfo
2636 @ifnotinfo
2637 see section @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/emacs-mime_6.html,
2638 Display Customization} in the @cite{The Emacs MIME Manual} and the
2639 documentation for the Gnus command @kbd{W h} (see section
2640 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_99.html, Article Washing} in the
2641 @cite{The Gnus Manual}).
2642 @end ifnotinfo
2643
2644 @cindex @file{.emacs}
2645 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
2646 @findex browse-url-at-mouse
2647 @kindex S-Mouse-2
2648
2649 A useful key binding that you can add to to @file{~/.emacs} is the
2650 following which displays an HTML link or textual URL in an external
2651 browser when clicked with @kbd{S-mouse-2}. This binding works in any
2652 buffer, including HTML buffers.
2653
2654 @smalllisp
2655 (global-set-key [S-mouse-2] 'browse-url-at-mouse)
2656 @end smalllisp
2657
2658 @node Digests, Reading PGP, HTML, Reading Mail
2659 @section Digests
2660
2661 @cindex digests
2662 @findex mh-page-digest
2663 @findex mh-page-digest-backwards
2664 @kindex D @key{BS}
2665 @kindex D @key{SPC}
2666 @kindex @key{BS}
2667 @kindex @key{SPC}
2668
2669 A digest is a message that contains other messages. Special MH-E
2670 commands let you read digests conveniently. You can use @key{SPC} and
2671 @key{BS} to page through the digest as if it were a normal message,
2672 but if you wish to skip to the next message in the digest, use
2673 @kbd{D @key{SPC}} (@code{mh-page-digest}). To return to a previous message,
2674 use @kbd{D @key{BS}} (@code{mh-page-digest-backwards}).
2675
2676 @cindex @command{burst}
2677 @cindex MH commands, @command{burst}
2678 @cindex MH-Folder Show mode
2679 @cindex modes, MH-Folder Show
2680 @findex mh-burst-digest
2681 @kindex d
2682 @kindex D b
2683 @kindex t
2684
2685 Another handy command is @kbd{D b} (@code{mh-burst-digest}). This
2686 command uses the MH command @command{burst}@footnote{See the section
2687 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/burdig.html, Bursting Messages} in the MH
2688 book.} to break out each message in the digest into its own message.
2689 Using this command, you can quickly delete unwanted messages, like
2690 this: Once the digest is split up, toggle out of MH-Folder Show mode
2691 with @kbd{t} (@pxref{Folders}) so that the scan lines fill the screen
2692 and messages aren't displayed. Then use @kbd{d} (@pxref{Reading Mail})
2693 to quickly delete messages that you don't want to read (based on the
2694 @samp{Subject:} header field). You can also burst the digest to reply
2695 directly to the people who posted the messages in the digest. One
2696 problem you may encounter is that the @samp{From:} header fields are
2697 preceded with a @samp{>} so that your reply can't create the
2698 @samp{To:} field correctly. In this case, you must correct the
2699 @samp{To:} field yourself. This is described later (@pxref{Editing
2700 Drafts}).
2701
2702 @node Reading PGP, Printing, Digests, Reading Mail
2703 @section Signed and Encrypted Messages
2704
2705 @cindex GPG
2706 @cindex GnuPG
2707 @cindex Gnus
2708 @cindex OpenPGP
2709 @cindex PGP
2710 @cindex RFC 3156
2711 @cindex encrypted messages
2712 @cindex security
2713 @cindex signed messages
2714
2715 You can read encrypted or signed PGP or GPG messages with
2716 MH-E@footnote{This feature depends on post-5.10 versions of Gnus.
2717 @cite{MIME Security with OpenPGP} is documented in
2718 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3156.txt, RFC 3156}. However,
2719 MH-E can also decrypt old-style PGP messages that are not in MIME
2720 format.}. This section assumes that you already have a good
2721 understanding of GPG and have set up your keys appropriately.
2722
2723 If someone sends you a signed message, here is what you'll see:
2724
2725 @smallexample
2726 @group
2727 [[PGP Signed Part:Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>]]
2728 This is a signed message.
2729
2730 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2731 @end group
2732 @end smallexample
2733
2734 @cindex keychain
2735 @cindex key server
2736 @cindex signed messages
2737
2738 If the key for the given signature is not in your keychain, you'll be
2739 given the opportunity to fetch the key from a key server and verify
2740 the key. If the message is really large, the verification process can
2741 take a long time. You can press @kbd{C-g} at any time to
2742 cancel@footnote{Unfortunately in the current version, the validation
2743 process doesn't display a message so it appears that MH-E has hung. We
2744 hope that this will be fixed in the future.}.
2745
2746 If the signature doesn't check out, you might see something like this:
2747
2748 @smallexample
2749 @group
2750 [[PGP Signed Part:Failed]]
2751 This is a signed message.
2752 This is garbage added after the signature was made.
2753
2754 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2755 @end group
2756 @end smallexample
2757
2758 @cindex decrypting messages
2759
2760 If someone sends you an encrypted message, MH-E will ask for your
2761 passphrase to decrypt the message. You should see something like this:
2762
2763 @smallexample
2764 @group
2765 [[PGP Encrypted Part:OK]]
2766
2767 [[PGP Signed Part:Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>]]
2768 This is the secret message.
2769
2770 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2771
2772 [[End of PGP Encrypted Part]]
2773 @end group
2774 @end smallexample
2775
2776 If there is a problem decrypting the message, the button will say:
2777
2778 @smallexample
2779 [[PGP Encrypted Part:Failed]]
2780 @end smallexample
2781
2782 You can read the contents of this button using the methods described in
2783 @ref{Viewing Attachments}. If the message were corrupted, you'd see
2784 this:
2785
2786 @smallexample
2787 [[PGP Encrypted Part:Failed]
2788 Invalid base64 data]
2789 @end smallexample
2790
2791 If your passphrase were incorrect, you'd see something like this:
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 [GNUPG:] ENC_TO CD9C88BB610BD9AD 1 0
2795 [GNUPG:] USERID_HINT CD9C88BB610BD9AD Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
2796 [GNUPG:] NEED_PASSPHRASE CD9C88BB610BD9AD CD9C88BB610BD9AD 1 0
2797 [GNUPG:] BAD_PASSPHRASE CD9C88BB610BD9AD
2798 gpg: encrypted with 1024-bit RSA key, ID 610BD9AD, created 1997-09-09
2799 "Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>"
2800 gpg: public key decryption failed: bad passphrase
2801 [GNUPG:] BEGIN_DECRYPTION
2802 [GNUPG:] DECRYPTION_FAILED
2803 gpg: decryption failed: secret key not available
2804 [GNUPG:] END_DECRYPTION
2805
2806 gpg exited abnormally: '2'
2807 @end smallexample
2808
2809 @vindex mh-show-pgg-bad
2810 @vindex mh-show-pgg-good
2811 @vindex mh-show-pgg-unknown
2812
2813 The appearance of the buttons is controlled by the faces
2814 @code{mh-show-pgg-good}, @code{mh-show-pgg-bad}, and
2815 @code{mh-show-pgg-unknown} depending on the validity of the signature.
2816 The latter is used whether the signature is unknown or untrusted.
2817
2818 @cindex @samp{pgg} customization group
2819 @cindex PGG
2820 @cindex customization group, @samp{pgg}
2821
2822 The @samp{pgg} customization group may have some settings which may
2823 interest you.
2824 @iftex
2825 See @cite{The PGG Manual}.
2826 @end iftex
2827 @ifinfo
2828 @xref{Top, , The PGG Manual, pgg, The PGG Manual}.
2829 @end ifinfo
2830 @ifhtml
2831 See
2832 @uref{http://www.dk.xemacs.org/Documentation/packages/html/pgg.html,
2833 @cite{The PGG Manual}}.
2834 @end ifhtml
2835
2836 @node Printing, Files and Pipes, Reading PGP, Reading Mail
2837 @section Printing Your Mail
2838
2839 @cindex printing
2840 @findex mh-ps-print-msg
2841 @findex mh-ps-print-msg-file
2842 @kindex P f
2843 @kindex P p
2844 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format
2845 @vindex mh-print-background-flag
2846
2847 To print messages in MH-E, use the command @kbd{P p}
2848 (@code{mh-ps-print-msg}). You can print all the messages in a range
2849 (as in @kbd{C-u P p 1 3 5-7 last:5 frombob @key{RET}},
2850 @pxref{Ranges}). You can also send the output to a file with @kbd{P f}
2851 (@code{mh-ps-print-msg-file}). This command will print inline text
2852 attachments but will not decrypt messages. However, when a message is
2853 displayed in an MH-Show buffer, then that buffer is used verbatim for
2854 printing with the caveat that only text attachments, if opened inline,
2855 are printed. Therefore, encrypted messages can be printed by showing
2856 and decrypting them first. The commands @kbd{P p} and @kbd{P f} do not
2857 use the options @code{mh-lpr-command-format} or
2858 @code{mh-print-background-flag}, described below.
2859
2860 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-color
2861 @kindex P C
2862 @vindex ps-print-color-p
2863
2864 Colors are emulated on black-and-white printers with shades of gray.
2865 This might produce illegible output, even if your screen colors only
2866 use shades of gray. If this is the case, try using the command @kbd{P
2867 C} (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-color}) to toggle between color, no
2868 color, and a black and white representation of the colors and see
2869 which works best. You change this setting permanently by customizing
2870 the option @code{ps-print-color-p}.
2871
2872 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-faces
2873 @kindex P F
2874
2875 Another related function is the command @kbd{P F}
2876 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-faces}). This command toggles between using
2877 faces and not. When faces are enabled, the printed message will look
2878 very similar to the message in the MH-Show buffer.
2879
2880 @cindex ps-print package
2881 @cindex Emacs, packages, ps-print
2882
2883 MH-E uses the @samp{ps-print} package to do the printing, so you can
2884 customize the printing further by going to the @samp{ps-print}
2885 customization group.
2886
2887 @cindex @command{lpr}
2888 @cindex @command{mhl}
2889 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
2890 @cindex Unix commands, @command{lpr}
2891 @findex mh-print-msg
2892 @kindex P l
2893
2894 An alternative to using the @samp{ps-print} package is the command
2895 @kbd{P l} (@code{mh-print-msg}) (the @i{l} is for @i{l}ine printer or
2896 @i{l}pr). You can print all the messages in a range. The message is
2897 formatted with @command{mhl}@footnote{See the section
2898 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in the MH
2899 book.} and printed with the @command{lpr} command.
2900
2901 @kindex P f
2902 @kindex P l
2903 @kindex P p
2904 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format
2905 @vindex mh-print-background-flag
2906
2907 The command @kbd{P l} uses two options. The option
2908 @code{mh-lpr-command-format} contains the Unix command line which
2909 performs the actual printing. The string can contain one escape,
2910 @samp{%s}, which is replaced by the name of the folder and the message
2911 number and is useful for print job names. The default setting is
2912 @code{"lpr -J '%s'"}. I use @code{"mpage -h'%s' -b Letter -H1of -mlrtb
2913 -P"} which produces a nice header and adds a bit of margin so the text
2914 fits within my printer's margins. Normally messages are printed in the
2915 foreground. If this is slow on your system, you may elect to turn on
2916 the option @code{mh-print-background-flag} to print in the background.
2917 If you do this, do not delete the message until it is printed or else
2918 the output may be truncated. These options are not used by the
2919 commands @kbd{P p} or @kbd{P f}.
2920
2921 @node Files and Pipes, Navigating, Printing, Reading Mail
2922 @section Files and Pipes
2923
2924 @cindex files
2925 @cindex pipes
2926 @findex mh-refile-or-write-again
2927 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
2928 @kindex >
2929 @kindex !
2930
2931 MH-E does offer a couple of commands that are not a part of MH@. The
2932 first one, @kbd{>} (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}), writes a message to
2933 a file. You are prompted for the filename. If the file already exists,
2934 the message is appended to it. You can also write the message to the
2935 file without the header by specifying a prefix argument (such as
2936 @kbd{C-u > /tmp/foobar @key{RET}}). Subsequent writes to the same file
2937 can be made with the command @kbd{!}
2938 (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}).
2939
2940 @findex mh-pipe-msg
2941 @kindex |
2942 @kindex l
2943
2944 You can also pipe the message through a Unix shell command with the
2945 command @kbd{|} (@code{mh-pipe-msg}). You are prompted for the Unix
2946 command through which you wish to run your message. If you give a
2947 prefix argument to this command, the message header is included in the
2948 text passed to the command (the contrived example @kbd{C-u | lpr}
2949 would be done with the @kbd{l} command instead).
2950
2951 @cindex @command{shar}
2952 @cindex @command{uuencode}
2953 @cindex Unix commands, @command{shar}
2954 @cindex Unix commands, @command{uuencode}
2955 @findex mh-store-msg
2956 @kindex X s
2957 @vindex mh-store-default-directory
2958
2959 If the message is a shell archive @command{shar} or has been run
2960 through @command{uuencode} use @kbd{X s} (@code{mh-store-msg}) to
2961 extract the body of the message. The default directory for extraction
2962 is the current directory; however, you have a chance to specify a
2963 different extraction directory. The next time you use this command,
2964 the default directory is the last directory you used. If you would
2965 like to change the initial default directory, customize the option
2966 @code{mh-store-default-directory}, change the value from
2967 @samp{Current} to @samp{Directory}, and then enter the name of the
2968 directory for storing the content of these messages.
2969
2970 @findex mh-store-buffer
2971 @kindex @key{RET}
2972 @kindex X s
2973
2974 By the way, @kbd{X s} calls the Emacs Lisp function
2975 @code{mh-store-buffer}. I mention this because you can use it directly
2976 if you're editing a buffer that contains a file that has been run
2977 through @command{uuencode} or @command{shar}. For example, you can
2978 extract the contents of the current buffer in your home directory by
2979 typing @kbd{M-x mh-store-buffer @key{RET} ~ @key{RET}}.
2980
2981 @node Navigating, Miscellaneous Commands and Options, Files and Pipes, Reading Mail
2982 @section Navigating
2983
2984 @cindex moving between messages
2985 @cindex navigation
2986 @findex mh-first-msg
2987 @findex mh-goto-msg
2988 @findex mh-last-msg
2989 @findex mh-next-undeleted-msg
2990 @findex mh-next-unread-msg
2991 @findex mh-previous-undeleted-msg
2992 @findex mh-previous-unread-msg
2993 @kindex g
2994 @kindex M-<
2995 @kindex M->
2996 @kindex M-n
2997 @kindex M-p
2998 @kindex n
2999 @kindex p
3000
3001 To move on to the next message, use the command @kbd{n}
3002 (@code{mh-next-undeleted-msg}); use @kbd{p}
3003 (@code{mh-previous-undeleted-msg}) to read the previous message. To
3004 move to the next unread message, use @kbd{M-n}
3005 (@code{mh-next-unread-msg}); use @kbd{M-p}
3006 (@code{mh-previous-unread-msg}) to move to the previous unread
3007 message. These commands can be given a prefix argument to specify how
3008 many messages to skip (for example, @kbd{5 n}). You can also move to a
3009 specific message with @kbd{g} (@code{mh-goto-msg}). You can enter the
3010 message number either before or after typing @kbd{g}. In the latter
3011 case, Emacs prompts you. Finally, you can go to the first or last
3012 message with @kbd{M-<} (@code{mh-first-msg}) and @kbd{M->}
3013 (@code{mh-last-msg}) respectively.
3014
3015 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3016 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3017 @findex next-line
3018 @findex previous-line
3019 @kindex C-n
3020 @kindex C-p
3021 @kindex @key{RET}
3022
3023 You can also use the Emacs commands @kbd{C-p} (@code{previous-line})
3024 and @kbd{C-n} (@code{next-line}) to move up and down the scan lines in
3025 the MH-Folder window. These commands can be used in conjunction with
3026 @key{RET} to look at deleted or refiled messages.
3027
3028 @cindex deleting messages
3029 @findex mh-delete-msg
3030 @kindex d
3031 @kindex n
3032 @kindex p
3033
3034 To mark a message for deletion, use the command @kbd{d}
3035 (@code{mh-delete-msg}). A @samp{D} is placed by the message in the
3036 scan window, and the next undeleted message is displayed. If the
3037 previous command had been @kbd{p}, then the next message displayed is
3038 the first undeleted message previous to the message just deleted. Use
3039 @kbd{n} to force subsequent @kbd{d} commands to move forward to the
3040 next undeleted message after deleting the message under the cursor.
3041 You may also specify a range (for example, @kbd{C-u d 1 3 5-7 last:5
3042 frombob @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
3043
3044 @findex mh-delete-msg-no-motion
3045 @kindex C-d
3046
3047 The command @kbd{C-d} (@code{mh-delete-msg-no-motion}) marks the
3048 message (or messages in range) for deletion but leaves the cursor at
3049 the current message in case you wish to perform other operations on
3050 the message.
3051
3052 @findex mh-delete-subject
3053 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
3054 @findex mh-thread-delete
3055 @findex mh-undo
3056 @kindex k
3057 @kindex T d
3058 @kindex u
3059
3060 And to delete more messages faster, you can use @kbd{k}
3061 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}) to delete all the messages with
3062 the same subject as the current message. This command puts these
3063 messages in a sequence named @samp{subject}. You can undo this action
3064 by using @kbd{u} (@code{mh-undo}) with a prefix argument and then
3065 specifying the @samp{subject} sequence. However, if the buffer is
3066 displaying a threaded view of the folder then @kbd{k} behaves like
3067 @kbd{T d} (@code{mh-thread-delete}). @xref{Threading}.
3068
3069 @findex mh-execute-commands
3070 @kindex x
3071
3072 However you mark a message for deletion, the command @kbd{x}
3073 (@code{mh-execute-commands}) actually carries out the deletion
3074 (@pxref{Folders}).
3075
3076 @vindex mh-delete-msg-hook
3077
3078 The hook @code{mh-delete-msg-hook} is called after you mark a message
3079 for deletion. For example, a past maintainer of MH-E used this once
3080 when he kept statistics on his mail usage.
3081
3082 @node Miscellaneous Commands and Options, , Navigating, Reading Mail
3083 @section Miscellaneous Commands and Options
3084
3085 This section contains a few more miscellaneous commands and options.
3086
3087 @cindex editing message
3088 @findex mh-modify
3089 @kindex M
3090
3091 There are times when you need to edit a message. For example, you may
3092 need to fix a broken Content-Type header field. You can do this with
3093 the command @kbd{M} (@code{mh-modify}). It displays the raw message in
3094 an editable buffer. When you are done editing, save and kill the
3095 buffer as you would any other.
3096
3097 @findex mh-kill-folder
3098 @findex mh-pack-folder
3099 @vindex mh-do-not-confirm-flag
3100
3101 Commands such as @code{mh-pack-folder} prompt to confirm whether to
3102 process outstanding moves and deletes or not before continuing.
3103 Turning on the option @code{mh-do-not-confirm-flag} means that these
3104 actions will be performed---which is usually desired but cannot be
3105 retracted---without question@footnote{In previous versions of MH-E,
3106 this option suppressed the confirmation in @code{mh-kill-folder}.
3107 Since this kept most users from setting this option,
3108 @code{mh-kill-folder} was modified in version 6.0 to always ask for
3109 confirmation subject to @code{mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hook}.
3110 @xref{Folders}.}.
3111
3112 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3113 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3114 @vindex mh-summary-height
3115
3116 The option @code{mh-summary-height} controls the number of scan lines
3117 displayed in the MH-Folder window, including the mode line. The
3118 default value of this option is @samp{Automatic} which means that the
3119 MH-Folder buffer will maintain the same proportional size if the frame
3120 is resized. If you'd prefer a fixed height, then choose the
3121 @samp{Fixed Size} option and enter the number of lines you'd like to
3122 see.
3123
3124 @vindex mh-bury-show-buffer-flag
3125
3126 Normally the buffer for displaying messages is buried at the bottom at
3127 the buffer stack. You may wish to disable this feature by turning off
3128 the option @code{mh-bury-show-buffer-flag}. One advantage of not
3129 burying the show buffer is that one can delete the show buffer more
3130 easily in an electric buffer list because of its proximity to its
3131 associated MH-Folder buffer. Try running @kbd{M-x
3132 electric-buffer-list} to see what I mean.
3133
3134 @cindex @file{.emacs}
3135 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
3136 @cindex reading mail
3137
3138 Before we leave this section, I'll include a function that I use as a
3139 front end to MH-E@footnote{Stephen Gildea's favorite binding is
3140 @kbd{(global-set-key "\C-cr" 'mh-rmail)}.}. It toggles between your
3141 working window configuration, which may be quite involved---windows
3142 filled with source, compilation output, man pages, and other
3143 documentation---and your MH-E window configuration. Like the rest of
3144 the customization described in this section, simply add the following
3145 code to @file{~/.emacs}.
3146
3147 @iftex
3148 @filbreak
3149 @end iftex
3150
3151 @findex mh-rmail, example
3152
3153 @smalllisp
3154 @group
3155 (defvar my-mh-screen-saved nil
3156 "Set to non-@code{nil} when MH-E window configuration shown.")
3157 (defvar my-normal-screen nil "Normal window configuration.")
3158 (defvar my-mh-screen nil "MH-E window configuration.")
3159
3160 (defun my-mh-rmail (&optional arg)
3161 "Toggle between MH-E and normal screen configurations.
3162 With non-@code{nil} or prefix argument, @i{inc} mailbox as well
3163 when going into mail."
3164 (interactive "P") ; @r{user callable function, P=prefix arg}
3165 (setq my-mh-screen-saved ; @r{save state}
3166 (cond
3167 ;; @r{Bring up MH-E screen if arg or normal window configuration.}
3168 ;; @r{If arg or +inbox buffer doesn't exist, run mh-rmail.}
3169 ((or arg (null my-mh-screen-saved))
3170 (setq my-normal-screen (current-window-configuration))
3171 (if (or arg (null (get-buffer "+inbox")))
3172 (mh-rmail)
3173 (set-window-configuration my-mh-screen))
3174 t) ; @r{set my-mh-screen-saved to @code{t}}
3175 ;; @r{Otherwise, save MH-E screen and restore normal screen.}
3176 (t
3177 (setq my-mh-screen (current-window-configuration))
3178 (set-window-configuration my-normal-screen)
3179 nil)))) ; @r{set my-mh-screen-saved to nil}
3180
3181 (global-set-key "\C-x\r" 'my-mh-rmail) ;@r{ call with C-x @key{RET}}
3182
3183 @i{Starting MH-E}
3184
3185 @end group
3186 @end smalllisp
3187
3188 If you type an argument (@kbd{C-u}) or if @code{my-mh-screen-saved} is
3189 @code{nil} (meaning a non-MH-E window configuration), the current
3190 window configuration is saved, either the @samp{+inbox} buffer is
3191 displayed or @code{mh-rmail} is run, and the MH-E window configuration
3192 is shown. Otherwise, the MH-E window configuration is saved and the
3193 original configuration is displayed.
3194
3195 @node Folders, Sending Mail, Reading Mail, Top
3196 @chapter Organizing Your Mail with Folders
3197
3198 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
3199 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
3200 @cindex folders
3201 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
3202 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
3203 @cindex using folders
3204
3205 This chapter discusses the things you can do with folders within MH-E.
3206 The commands in this chapter are also found in the @samp{Folder} and
3207 @samp{Message} menus.
3208
3209 @table @kbd
3210 @kindex ?
3211 @findex mh-help
3212 @item ?
3213 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
3214 @c -------------------------
3215 @kindex !
3216 @findex mh-refile-or-write-again
3217 @item !
3218 Repeat last output command (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}).
3219 @c -------------------------
3220 @cindex @samp{Message > Copy Message to Folder...} menu item
3221 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Copy Message to Folder...}
3222 @kindex c
3223 @findex mh-copy-msg
3224 @item c
3225 Copy range to folder (@code{mh-copy-msg}).
3226 @c -------------------------
3227 @kindex F ?
3228 @findex mh-prefix-help
3229 @item F ?
3230 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
3231 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
3232 @c -------------------------
3233 @kindex F '
3234 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
3235 @item F '
3236 Display ticked messages (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}).
3237 @c -------------------------
3238 @kindex F c
3239 @findex mh-catchup
3240 @item F c
3241 Delete range from the @samp{unseen} sequence (@code{mh-catchup}).
3242 @c -------------------------
3243 @kindex F k
3244 @findex mh-kill-folder
3245 @item F k
3246 Remove folder (@code{mh-kill-folder}).
3247 @c -------------------------
3248 @cindex @samp{Folder > List Folders} menu item
3249 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > List Folders}
3250 @kindex F l
3251 @findex mh-list-folders
3252 @item F l
3253 List all folders (@code{mh-list-folders}).
3254 @c -------------------------
3255 @cindex @samp{Folder > View New Messages} menu item
3256 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > View New Messages}
3257 @kindex F n
3258 @findex mh-index-new-messages
3259 @item F n
3260 Display unseen messages (@code{mh-index-new-messages}).
3261 @c -------------------------
3262 @cindex @samp{Folder > Pack Folder} menu item
3263 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Pack Folder}
3264 @kindex F p
3265 @findex mh-pack-folder
3266 @item F p
3267 Pack folder (@code{mh-pack-folder}).
3268 @c -------------------------
3269 @kindex F q
3270 @findex mh-index-sequenced-messages
3271 @item F q
3272 Display messages in any sequence (@code{mh-index-sequenced-messages}).
3273 @c -------------------------
3274 @cindex @samp{Folder > Rescan Folder} menu item
3275 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Rescan Folder}
3276 @kindex F r
3277 @findex mh-rescan-folder
3278 @item F r
3279 Rescan folder (@code{mh-rescan-folder}).
3280 @c -------------------------
3281 @cindex @samp{Folder > Search...} menu item
3282 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Search...}
3283 @kindex F s
3284 @findex mh-search
3285 @item F s
3286 Search your MH mail (@code{mh-search}).
3287 @c -------------------------
3288 @cindex @samp{Folder > Sort Folder} menu item
3289 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Sort Folder}
3290 @kindex F S
3291 @findex mh-sort-folder
3292 @item F S
3293 Sort folder (@code{mh-sort-folder}).
3294 @c -------------------------
3295 @kindex F u
3296 @findex mh-undo-folder
3297 @item F u
3298 Undo all refiles and deletes in the current folder (@code{mh-undo-folder}).
3299 @c -------------------------
3300 @cindex @samp{Folder > Visit a Folder...} menu item
3301 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Visit a Folder...}
3302 @kindex F v
3303 @findex mh-visit-folder
3304 @item F v
3305 Visit folder (@code{mh-visit-folder}).
3306 @c -------------------------
3307 @cindex @samp{Message > Refile Message} menu item
3308 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Refile Message}
3309 @kindex o
3310 @findex mh-refile-msg
3311 @item o
3312 Refile (output) range into folder (@code{mh-refile-msg}).
3313 @c -------------------------
3314 @cindex @samp{Folder > Quit MH-E} menu item
3315 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Quit MH-E}
3316 @kindex q
3317 @findex mh-quit
3318 @item q
3319 Quit the current MH-E folder (@code{mh-quit}).
3320 @c -------------------------
3321 @cindex @samp{Folder > Toggle Show/Folder} menu item
3322 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Toggle Show/Folder}
3323 @kindex t
3324 @findex mh-toggle-showing
3325 @item t
3326 Toggle between MH-Folder and MH-Folder Show modes
3327 (@code{mh-toggle-showing}).
3328 @c -------------------------
3329 @cindex @samp{Message > Undo Delete/Refile} menu item
3330 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Undo Delete/Refile}
3331 @kindex u
3332 @findex mh-undo
3333 @item u
3334 Undo pending deletes or refiles in range (@code{mh-undo}).
3335 @c -------------------------
3336 @cindex @samp{Message > Execute Delete/Refile} menu item
3337 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Execute Delete/Refile}
3338 @kindex x
3339 @findex mh-execute-commands
3340 @item x
3341 Process outstanding delete and refile requests
3342 (@code{mh-execute-commands}).
3343 @end table
3344
3345 @cindex @samp{mh-folder} customization group
3346 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-folder}
3347
3348 The @samp{mh-folder} customization group is used to tune these
3349 commands.
3350
3351 @vtable @code
3352 @item mh-new-messages-folders
3353 Folders searched for the @samp{unseen} sequence (default:
3354 @code{Inbox}).
3355 @c -------------------------
3356 @item mh-ticked-messages-folders
3357 Folders searched for @code{mh-tick-seq} (default: @code{t}).
3358 @c -------------------------
3359 @item mh-large-folder
3360 The number of messages that indicates a large folder (default: 200).
3361 @c -------------------------
3362 @item mh-recenter-summary-flag
3363 On means to recenter the summary window (default: @samp{off}).
3364 @c -------------------------
3365 @item mh-recursive-folders-flag
3366 On means that commands which operate on folders do so recursively
3367 (default: @samp{off}).
3368 @c -------------------------
3369 @item mh-sortm-args
3370 Additional arguments for @command{sortm} (default: @code{nil}).
3371 @end vtable
3372
3373 The following hooks are available.
3374
3375 @vtable @code
3376 @item mh-after-commands-processed-hook
3377 Hook run by @kbd{x} after performing outstanding refile and delete
3378 requests (default: @code{nil}).
3379 @c -------------------------
3380 @item mh-before-commands-processed-hook
3381 Hook run by @kbd{x} before performing outstanding refile and delete
3382 requests (default: @code{nil}).
3383 @c -------------------------
3384 @item mh-before-quit-hook
3385 Hook run by q before quitting MH-E (default: @code{nil}).
3386 @c -------------------------
3387 @item mh-folder-mode-hook
3388 Hook run by @code{mh-folder-mode} when visiting a new folder (default:
3389 @code{nil}).
3390 @c -------------------------
3391 @item mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hook
3392 Abnormal hook run at the beginning of @code{mh-kill-folder} (default:
3393 @code{'mh-search-p}).
3394 @c -------------------------
3395 @item mh-quit-hook
3396 Hook run by q after quitting MH-E (default: @code{nil}).
3397 @c -------------------------
3398 @item mh-refile-msg-hook
3399 Hook run by o after marking each message for refiling (default:
3400 @code{nil}).
3401 @end vtable
3402
3403 The following faces are available for customizing the appearance of
3404 the MH-Folder buffer. @xref{Scan Line Formats}.
3405
3406 @vtable @code
3407 @item mh-folder-address
3408 Recipient face.
3409 @c -------------------------
3410 @item mh-folder-body
3411 Body text face.
3412 @c -------------------------
3413 @item mh-folder-cur-msg-number
3414 Current message number face.
3415 @c -------------------------
3416 @item mh-folder-date
3417 Date face.
3418 @c -------------------------
3419 @item mh-folder-deleted
3420 Deleted message face.
3421 @c -------------------------
3422 @item mh-folder-followup
3423 @samp{Re:} face.
3424 @c -------------------------
3425 @item mh-folder-msg-number
3426 Message number face.
3427 @c -------------------------
3428 @item mh-folder-refiled
3429 Refiled message face.
3430 @c -------------------------
3431 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
3432 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
3433 @item mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint
3434 Fontification hint face in messages sent directly to us. The detection
3435 of messages sent to us is governed by the scan format
3436 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} and regular expression
3437 @code{mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp}.
3438 @c -------------------------
3439 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
3440 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
3441 @item mh-folder-scan-format
3442 Sender face in messages sent directly to us. The detection of messages
3443 sent to us is governed by the scan format @code{mh-scan-format-nmh}
3444 and regular expression @code{mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp}.
3445 @c -------------------------
3446 @item mh-folder-subject
3447 Subject face.
3448 @c -------------------------
3449 @item mh-folder-tick
3450 Ticked message face.
3451 @c -------------------------
3452 @item mh-folder-to
3453 @samp{To:} face.
3454 @end vtable
3455
3456 @vindex mh-folder-mode-hook
3457
3458 The hook @code{mh-folder-mode-hook} is called when visiting a new
3459 folder in MH-Folder mode. This could be used to set your own key
3460 bindings, for example:
3461
3462 @vindex mh-folder-mode-hook, example
3463
3464 @smalllisp
3465 @group
3466 (defvar my-mh-init-done nil
3467 "Non-@code{nil} when one-time MH-E settings made.")
3468
3469 (defun my-mh-folder-mode-hook ()
3470 "Hook to set key bindings in MH-Folder mode."
3471 (if (not my-mh-init-done) ; @r{only need to bind the keys once }
3472 (progn
3473 (local-set-key "//" 'my-search-msg)
3474 (local-set-key "b" 'mh-burst-digest) ; @r{better use of @kbd{b}}
3475 (setq my-mh-init-done t))))
3476
3477 (add-hook 'mh-folder-mode-hook 'my-mh-folder-mode-hook)
3478
3479 (defun my-search-msg ()
3480 "Search for a regexp in the current message."
3481 (interactive) ; @r{user function}
3482 (save-window-excursion
3483 (other-window 1) ; @r{go to next window}
3484 (isearch-forward-regexp))) ; @r{string search; hit return}
3485 ; @r{ when done}
3486
3487 @i{Create additional key bindings via mh-folder-mode-hook}
3488
3489 @end group
3490 @end smalllisp
3491
3492 @cindex @command{folder}
3493 @cindex @command{refile}
3494 @cindex MH commands, @command{folder}
3495 @cindex MH commands, @command{refile}
3496 @findex mh-refile-msg
3497 @kindex o
3498 @vindex mh-refile-msg-hook
3499
3500 MH-E has analogies for each of the MH @command{folder} and
3501 @command{refile} commands@footnote{See the sections
3502 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/fol.html#Youfol, Your Current Folder:
3503 folder} and @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/fol.html#Movref, Moving and
3504 Linking Messages: refile} in the MH book.}. To refile a message in
3505 another folder, use the command @kbd{o} (@code{mh-refile-msg})
3506 (mnemonic: ``output''). You are prompted for the folder name
3507 (@pxref{Folder Selection}). Note that this command can also be used to
3508 create folders. If you specify a folder that does not exist, you will
3509 be prompted to create it. The hook @code{mh-refile-msg-hook} is called
3510 after a message is marked to be refiled.
3511
3512 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
3513 @kindex !
3514
3515 If you are refiling several messages into the same folder, you can use
3516 the command @kbd{!} (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}) to repeat the
3517 last refile or write (for the description of @kbd{>}
3518 (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}), @pxref{Files and Pipes}). You can use a
3519 range in either case (for example, @kbd{C-u o 1 3 5-7 last:5 frombob
3520 @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
3521
3522 @cindex expunging refiles and deletes
3523 @cindex undoing refiles and deletes
3524 @findex mh-undo
3525 @kindex u
3526
3527 If you've deleted a message or refiled it, but changed your mind, you
3528 can cancel the action before you've executed it. Use @kbd{u}
3529 (@code{mh-undo}) to undo a refile on or deletion of a single message.
3530 You can also undo refiles and deletes for messages that are found in a
3531 given range (@pxref{Ranges}).
3532
3533 @findex mh-undo-folder
3534 @kindex F u
3535
3536 Alternatively, you can use @kbd{F u} (@code{mh-undo-folder}) to undo
3537 all refiles and deletes in the current folder.
3538
3539 @findex mh-execute-commands
3540 @kindex x
3541
3542 If you've marked messages to be deleted or refiled and you want to go
3543 ahead and delete or refile the messages, use @kbd{x}
3544 (@code{mh-execute-commands}). Many MH-E commands that may affect the
3545 numbering of the messages (such as @kbd{F r} or @kbd{F p}) will ask if
3546 you want to process refiles or deletes first and then either run
3547 @kbd{x} for you or undo the pending refiles and deletes.
3548
3549 @kindex x
3550 @vindex mh-after-commands-processed-hook
3551 @vindex mh-before-commands-processed-hook
3552
3553 The command @kbd{x} runs @code{mh-before-commands-processed-hook}
3554 before the commands are processed and
3555 @code{mh-after-commands-processed-hook} after the commands are
3556 processed. Variables that are useful with the former hook include
3557 @code{mh-delete-list} and @code{mh-refile-list} which can be used to
3558 see which changes will be made to the current folder,
3559 @code{mh-current-folder}. Variables that are useful with the latter
3560 hook include @code{mh-folders-changed}, which lists which folders were
3561 affected by deletes and refiles. This list will always include the
3562 current folder @code{mh-current-folder}.
3563
3564 @findex mh-copy-msg
3565 @kindex c
3566 @kindex o
3567
3568 If you wish to copy a message to another folder, you can use the
3569 command @kbd{c} (@code{mh-copy-msg}) (see the @option{-link} argument
3570 to @command{refile}(1)). Like the command @kbd{o}, this command
3571 prompts you for the name of the target folder and you can specify a
3572 range (@pxref{Ranges}). Note that unlike the command @kbd{o}, the copy
3573 takes place immediately. The original copy remains in the current
3574 folder.
3575
3576 @cindex junk mail
3577 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3578 @cindex MH-Folder Show mode
3579 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3580 @cindex modes, MH-Folder Show
3581 @cindex spam
3582 @findex mh-toggle-showing
3583 @kindex t
3584
3585 The command @kbd{t} (@code{mh-toggle-showing}) switches between
3586 MH-Folder mode and MH-Folder Show mode@footnote{For you Emacs wizards,
3587 this is implemented as an Emacs minor mode.}. MH-Folder mode turns off
3588 the associated show buffer so that you can perform operations on the
3589 messages quickly without reading them. This is an excellent way to
3590 prune out your junk mail or to refile a group of messages to another
3591 folder for later examination.
3592
3593 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3594 @cindex MH-Show mode
3595 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3596 @cindex modes, MH-Show
3597 @cindex moving between messages
3598 @kindex t
3599 @vindex mh-recenter-summary-flag
3600
3601 When you use @kbd{t} to toggle from MH-Folder Show mode to MH-Folder
3602 mode, the MH-Show buffer is hidden and the MH-Folder buffer is left
3603 alone. Setting @code{mh-recenter-summary-flag} to a non-@code{nil}
3604 value causes the toggle to display as many scan lines as possible,
3605 with the cursor at the middle. The effect of
3606 @code{mh-recenter-summary-flag} is rather useful, but it can be
3607 annoying on a slow network connection.
3608
3609 @findex mh-visit-folder
3610 @kindex F v
3611 @vindex mh-large-folder
3612
3613 When you want to read the messages that you have refiled into folders,
3614 use the command @kbd{F v} (@code{mh-visit-folder}) to visit the
3615 folder. You are prompted for the folder name. The folder buffer will
3616 show just unseen messages if there are any; otherwise, it will show
3617 all the messages in the buffer as long there are fewer than
3618 @code{mh-large-folder} messages. If there are more, then you are
3619 prompted for a range of messages to scan. You can provide a prefix
3620 argument in order to specify a range of messages to show when you
3621 visit the folder (@pxref{Ranges}). In this case, regions are not used
3622 to specify the range and @code{mh-large-folder} is ignored. Note that
3623 this command can also be used to create folders. If you specify a
3624 folder that does not exist, you will be prompted to create it.
3625
3626 @findex mh-search
3627 @kindex F s
3628
3629 If you forget where you've refiled your messages, you can find them
3630 using @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}). @xref{Searching}.
3631
3632 @cindex @command{procmail}
3633 @cindex @samp{unseen} sequence
3634 @cindex sequence, @samp{unseen}
3635 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
3636 @cindex unseen messages, viewing
3637 @findex mh-index-new-messages
3638 @kindex F n
3639 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3640
3641 If you use a program such as @command{procmail} to file your incoming
3642 mail automatically, you can display new, unseen, messages using the
3643 command @kbd{F n} (@code{mh-index-new-messages}). All messages in the
3644 @samp{unseen} sequence from the folders in
3645 @code{mh-new-messages-folders} are listed. However, this list of
3646 folders can be overridden with a prefix argument: with a prefix
3647 argument, enter a space-separated list of folders, or nothing to
3648 search all folders.
3649
3650 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
3651 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
3652 @cindex ticked messages, viewing
3653 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
3654 @kindex F '
3655 @vindex mh-ticked-messages-folders
3656
3657 If you have ticked messages (@pxref{Sequences}), you can display them
3658 using the command @kbd{F '} (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}). All
3659 messages in the @samp{tick} sequence from the folders in
3660 @code{mh-ticked-messages-folders} are listed. With a prefix argument,
3661 enter a space-separated list of folders, or nothing to search all
3662 folders.
3663
3664 @findex mh-index-sequenced-messages
3665 @kindex F q
3666 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3667
3668 You can display messages in any sequence with the command @kbd{F q}
3669 (@code{mh-index-sequenced-messages}). All messages from the folders in
3670 @code{mh-new-messages-folders} in the sequence you provide are listed.
3671 With a prefix argument, enter a space-separated list of folders at the
3672 prompt, or nothing to search all folders.
3673
3674 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3675 @vindex mh-recursive-folders-flag
3676 @vindex mh-ticked-messages-folders
3677
3678 Set the options @code{mh-new-messages-folders} and
3679 @code{mh-ticked-messages-folders} to @samp{Inbox} to search the
3680 @samp{+inbox} folder or @samp{All} to search all of the top level
3681 folders. Otherwise, list the folders that should be searched with the
3682 @samp{Choose Folders} menu item. See @code{mh-recursive-folders-flag}.
3683
3684 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3685 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3686 @findex mh-kill-folder
3687 @findex mh-list-folders
3688 @findex mh-pack-folder
3689 @findex mh-rescan-folder
3690 @findex mh-sort-folder
3691 @kindex F k
3692 @kindex F l
3693 @kindex F p
3694 @kindex F r
3695 @kindex F S
3696
3697 Other commands you can perform on folders include: @kbd{F l}
3698 (@code{mh-list-folders}), to place a listing of all the folders in
3699 your mail directory in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3700 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}); @kbd{F k} (@code{mh-kill-folder}), to remove
3701 a folder; @kbd{F S} (@code{mh-sort-folder}), to sort the messages by
3702 date (see @command{sortm}(1) to see how to sort by other criteria);
3703 @kbd{F p} (@code{mh-pack-folder}), to pack a folder, removing gaps
3704 from the numbering sequence; and @kbd{F r} (@code{mh-rescan-folder}),
3705 to rescan the folder, which is useful to grab all messages in your
3706 @samp{+inbox} after processing your new mail for the first time. If
3707 you don't want to rescan the entire folder, the commands @kbd{F r} or
3708 @kbd{F p} will accept a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
3709
3710 @kindex @key{TAB}
3711 @vindex mh-recursive-folders-flag
3712
3713 By default, operations on folders work only one level at a time. Set
3714 @code{mh-recursive-folders-flag} to non-@code{nil} to operate on all
3715 folders. This mostly means that you'll be able to see all your folders
3716 when you press @key{TAB} when prompted for a folder name.
3717
3718 @findex mh-search-p
3719 @kindex k
3720 @vindex mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hooks
3721
3722 The hook @code{mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hooks} is an abnormal
3723 hook run at the beginning of the command @kbd{k}. The hook functions
3724 are called with no arguments and should return a non-nil value to
3725 suppress the normal prompt when you remove a folder. This is useful
3726 for folders that are easily regenerated. The default value of
3727 @code{mh-search-p} suppresses the prompt on folders generated by
3728 searching.
3729
3730 @sp 1
3731 @center @strong{NOTE}
3732
3733 @quotation
3734 Use this hook with care. If there is a bug in your hook which returns
3735 @code{t} on @samp{+inbox} and you press @kbd{k} by accident in the
3736 @code{+inbox} folder, you will not be happy.
3737 @end quotation
3738 @sp 1
3739
3740 @cindex @command{sortm}
3741 @cindex @file{.mh_profile}
3742 @cindex files, @file{.mh_profile}
3743 @cindex MH commands, @command{sortm}
3744 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{sortm:}
3745 @cindex @samp{sortm:} MH profile component
3746 @kindex F S
3747 @vindex mh-sortm-args
3748
3749 The option @code{mh-sortm-args} holds extra arguments to pass on to
3750 the command @command{sortm}@footnote{See the section
3751 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sorsor.html, Sorting Messages: sortm} in the
3752 MH book.} when a prefix argument is used with @kbd{F S}. Normally
3753 default arguments to @command{sortm} are specified in the MH profile.
3754 This option may be used to provide an alternate view. For example,
3755 @samp{'(\"-nolimit\" \"-textfield\" \"subject\")} is a useful setting.
3756
3757 @cindex exiting
3758 @cindex quitting
3759 @findex mh-quit
3760 @kindex q
3761
3762 When you want to quit using MH-E and go back to editing, you can use
3763 the @kbd{q} (@code{mh-quit}) command. This buries the buffers of the
3764 current MH-E folder and restores the buffers that were present when
3765 you first ran @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}. It also removes any MH-E working
3766 buffers whose name begins with @samp{ *mh-} or @samp{*MH-E }
3767 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}). You can later restore your MH-E session by
3768 selecting the @samp{+inbox} buffer or by running @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}
3769 again.
3770
3771 @findex mh-execute-commands
3772 @kindex q
3773 @vindex mh-before-quit-hook
3774 @vindex mh-before-quit-hook, example
3775 @vindex mh-quit-hook
3776 @vindex mh-quit-hook, example
3777
3778 The two hooks @code{mh-before-quit-hook} and @code{mh-quit-hook} are
3779 called by @kbd{q}. The former one is called before the quit occurs, so
3780 you might use it to perform any MH-E operations; you could perform
3781 some query and abort the quit or call @code{mh-execute-commands}, for
3782 example. The latter is not run in an MH-E context, so you might use it
3783 to modify the window setup. If you find that @kbd{q} buries a lot of
3784 buffers that you would rather remove, you can use both
3785 @code{mh-before-quit-hook} and @code{mh-quit-hook} to accomplish that.
3786
3787 @smalllisp
3788 @group
3789 (defvar my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete nil
3790 "Folder buffer that is being quit.")
3791
3792 (defun my-mh-before-quit-hook ()
3793 "Save folder buffer that is to be deleted."
3794 (setq my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete (current-buffer)))
3795
3796 (defun my-mh-quit-hook ()
3797 "Kill folder buffer rather than just bury it."
3798 (set-buffer my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete)
3799 (if (get-buffer mh-show-buffer)
3800 (kill-buffer mh-show-buffer))
3801 (kill-buffer (current-buffer)))
3802
3803 @i{Kill MH-Folder buffer instead of burying it}
3804 @end group
3805 @end smalllisp
3806
3807 @cindex folders, renaming
3808 @cindex renaming folders
3809 @findex dired
3810 @findex dired-do-rename
3811
3812 You can use dired to manipulate the folders themselves. For example, I
3813 renamed my @samp{+out} folder to the more common @samp{+outbox} by
3814 running dired on my mail directory (@kbd{M-x dired RET ~/Mail RET}),
3815 moving my cursor to @samp{out} and using the command @kbd{R}
3816 (@code{dired-do-rename}).
3817
3818 @node Sending Mail, Editing Drafts, Folders, Top
3819 @chapter Sending Mail
3820
3821 @cindex sending mail
3822 @findex mh-smail
3823 @kindex M-x mh-smail
3824
3825 You can send a mail message in several ways. You can call @kbd{M-x
3826 mh-smail} directly, or from the command line like this:
3827
3828 @cindex starting from command line
3829
3830 @smallexample
3831 $ @kbd{emacs -f mh-smail}
3832 @end smallexample
3833
3834 @findex goto-address-at-point
3835 @vindex mail-user-agent
3836
3837 There are some commands that need to send a mail message, such as
3838 @code{goto-address-at-point}. You can configure Emacs to have these
3839 commands use MH-E by setting the option @code{mail-user-agent} to
3840 @samp{Emacs interface to MH}.
3841
3842 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
3843 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
3844
3845 From within MH-E's MH-Folder mode, other methods of sending mail are
3846 available as well. These can also be found in the @samp{Message} menu.
3847
3848 @table @kbd
3849 @cindex @samp{Message > Edit Message Again} menu item
3850 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Edit Message Again}
3851 @kindex e
3852 @findex mh-edit-again
3853 @item e
3854 Edit a message to send it again (@code{mh-edit-again}).
3855 @c -------------------------
3856 @cindex @samp{Message > Re-edit a Bounced Message} menu item
3857 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Re-edit a Bounced Message}
3858 @kindex E
3859 @findex mh-extract-rejected-mail
3860 @item E
3861 Edit a message that was returned by the mail system
3862 (@code{mh-extract-rejected-mail}).
3863 @c -------------------------
3864 @cindex @samp{Message > Forward Message...} menu item
3865 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Forward Message...}
3866 @kindex f
3867 @findex mh-forward
3868 @item f
3869 Forward message (@code{mh-forward}).
3870 @c -------------------------
3871 @cindex @samp{Message > Reply to Message...} menu item
3872 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Reply to Message...}
3873 @kindex r
3874 @findex mh-reply
3875 @item r
3876 Reply to a message (@code{mh-reply}).
3877 @c -------------------------
3878 @cindex @samp{Message > Compose a New Message} menu item
3879 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Compose a New Message}
3880 @kindex s
3881 @findex mh-send
3882 @item s
3883 Compose a message (@code{mh-send}).
3884 @c -------------------------
3885 @cindex @samp{Message > Redistribute Message...} menu item
3886 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Redistribute Message...}
3887 @kindex M-d
3888 @findex mh-redistribute
3889 @item M-d
3890 Redistribute a message (@code{mh-redistribute}).
3891 @c -------------------------
3892 @findex mh-smail
3893 @item M-x mh-smail
3894 Compose a message with the MH mail system.
3895 @c -------------------------
3896 @findex mh-smail-other-window
3897 @item M-x mh-smail-other-window
3898 Compose a message with the MH mail system in other window.
3899 @end table
3900
3901 @cindex @samp{mh-sending-mail} customization group
3902 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-sending-mail}
3903
3904 In addition, several options from the @samp{mh-sending-mail}
3905 customization group are useful when sending mail or replying to mail.
3906 They are summarized in the following table.
3907
3908 @vtable @code
3909 @item mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag
3910 On means that messages are forwarded as attachments (default:
3911 @samp{on}).
3912 @c -------------------------
3913 @item mh-compose-letter-function
3914 Hook run when starting a new draft (default: @code{nil}).
3915 @c -------------------------
3916 @item mh-compose-prompt-flag
3917 On means prompt for header fields when composing a new draft (default:
3918 @samp{off}).
3919 @c -------------------------
3920 @item mh-forward-subject-format
3921 Format string for forwarded message subject (default: @code{"%s:
3922 %s"}).
3923 @c -------------------------
3924 @item mh-insert-x-mailer-flag
3925 On means append an @samp{X-Mailer:} header field to the header
3926 (default: @samp{on}).
3927 @c -------------------------
3928 @item mh-redist-full-contents-flag
3929 On means the @command{dist} command needs entire letter for
3930 redistribution (default: @samp{off}).
3931 @c -------------------------
3932 @item mh-reply-default-reply-to
3933 Sets the person or persons to whom a reply will be sent (default:
3934 @samp{Prompt}).
3935 @c -------------------------
3936 @item mh-reply-show-message-flag
3937 On means the MH-Show buffer is displayed using @kbd{r}
3938 (@code{mh-reply}) (default: @samp{on}).
3939 @end vtable
3940
3941 The following hooks are available.
3942
3943 @vtable @code
3944 @item mh-forward-hook
3945 Hook run by @code{mh-forward} on a forwarded letter (default:
3946 @code{nil}).
3947 @c -------------------------
3948 @item mh-letter-mode-hook
3949 Hook run by @code{mh-letter-mode} on a new letter (default:
3950 @code{nil}).
3951 @end vtable
3952
3953 The functions and options introduced here are explained in more detail
3954 in the following sections.
3955
3956 @menu
3957 * Composing::
3958 * Replying::
3959 * Forwarding::
3960 * Redistributing::
3961 * Editing Again::
3962 @end menu
3963
3964 @node Composing, Replying, Sending Mail, Sending Mail
3965 @section Composing
3966
3967 @cindex @file{.emacs}
3968 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3969 @cindex composing mail
3970 @cindex draft
3971 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
3972 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3973 @cindex sending mail
3974 @findex mh-smail
3975 @findex mh-smail-other-window
3976 @kindex M-x mh-smail
3977 @kindex M-x mh-smail-other-window
3978
3979 Outside of an MH-Folder buffer, you must call either @kbd{M-x
3980 mh-smail} or @kbd{M-x mh-smail-other-window} to compose a new message.
3981 The former command always creates a two-window layout with the current
3982 buffer on top and the draft on the bottom. Use the latter command if
3983 you would rather preserve the window layout. You may find adding the
3984 following key bindings to @file{~/.emacs} useful:
3985
3986 @smalllisp
3987 (global-set-key "\C-xm" 'mh-smail)
3988 (global-set-key "\C-x4m" 'mh-smail-other-window)
3989 @end smalllisp
3990
3991 @cindex draft folder
3992 @cindex MH-Letter mode
3993 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
3994 @findex mh-send
3995 @kindex m
3996
3997 From within a MH-Folder buffer, you can simply use the command @kbd{m}
3998 (@code{mh-send}). However you invoke @code{mh-send}, your letter
3999 appears in an Emacs buffer whose mode is MH-Letter (to see what the
4000 buffer looks like, @pxref{Sending Mail Tour}). MH-Letter mode allows
4001 you to edit your message, to check the validity of the recipients, to
4002 insert attachments and other messages into your message, and to send
4003 the message. We'll go more into depth about editing a
4004 @dfn{draft}@footnote{I highly recommend that you use a @dfn{draft
4005 folder} so that you can edit several drafts in parallel. To do so,
4006 create a folder named @samp{+drafts} for example, and add the profile
4007 component @samp{Draft-Folder: drafts} (see @code{mh-profile}(5)).} (a
4008 message you're composing) in just a moment (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
4009
4010 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
4011
4012 If you prefer to be prompted for the recipient and subject fields
4013 before the MH-Letter buffer appears, turn on the option
4014 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag}.
4015
4016 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Mailer:}
4017 @cindex @samp{X-Mailer:} header field
4018 @vindex mh-insert-x-mailer-flag
4019
4020 MH-E adds an @samp{X-Mailer:} header field to the header that includes
4021 the version of MH-E and Emacs that you are using. If you don't want to
4022 participate in our marketing, you can turn off the option
4023 @code{mh-insert-x-mailer-flag}.
4024
4025 @cindex @command{repl}
4026 @cindex @file{components}
4027 @cindex MH commands, @command{repl}
4028 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4029 @cindex Mail mode
4030 @cindex files, @file{components}
4031 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4032 @cindex modes, Mail
4033 @vindex mail-mode-hook
4034 @vindex mh-letter-mode-hook
4035 @vindex text-mode-hook
4036
4037 Two hooks are provided to run commands on your freshly created draft.
4038 The first hook, @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}, allows you to do some
4039 processing before editing a letter@footnote{Actually, because
4040 MH-Letter mode inherits from Mail mode, the hooks
4041 @code{text-mode-hook} and @code{mail-mode-hook} are run (in that
4042 order) before @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}.}. For example, you may wish
4043 to modify the header after @command{repl} has done its work, or you
4044 may have a complicated @file{components} file and need to tell MH-E
4045 where the cursor should go. Here's an example of how you would use
4046 this hook.
4047
4048 @findex mh-insert-signature, example
4049
4050 @smalllisp
4051 @group
4052 (defvar letter-mode-init-done-flag nil
4053 "Non-nil means one-time MH-E settings have been made.")
4054
4055 (defun my-mh-letter-mode-hook ()
4056 "Prepare letter for editing."
4057 (when (not letter-mode-init-done) ; @r{only need to bind the keys once}
4058 (local-set-key "\C-ctb" 'add-enriched-text)
4059 (local-set-key "\C-cti" 'add-enriched-text)
4060 (local-set-key "\C-ctf" 'add-enriched-text)
4061 (local-set-key "\C-cts" 'add-enriched-text)
4062 (local-set-key "\C-ctB" 'add-enriched-text)
4063 (local-set-key "\C-ctu" 'add-enriched-text)
4064 (local-set-key "\C-ctc" 'add-enriched-text)
4065 (setq letter-mode-init-done t))
4066 (save-excursion
4067 (goto-char (point-max)) ; @r{go to end of message to}
4068 (mh-insert-signature))) ; @r{insert signature}
4069
4070 @i{Prepare draft for editing via mh-letter-mode-hook}
4071
4072 @end group
4073 @end smalllisp
4074
4075 The function, @code{add-enriched-text} is defined in the example in
4076 @ref{Adding Attachments}.
4077
4078 @vindex mh-compose-letter-function
4079 @vindex mh-letter-mode-hook
4080
4081 The second hook, a function really, is
4082 @code{mh-compose-letter-function}. Like @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}, it
4083 is called just before editing a new message; however, it is the last
4084 function called before you edit your message. The consequence of this
4085 is that you can write a function to write and send the message for
4086 you. This function is passed three arguments: the contents of the
4087 @samp{To:}, @samp{Subject:}, and @samp{Cc:} header fields.
4088
4089 @node Replying, Forwarding, Composing, Sending Mail
4090 @section Replying to Mail
4091
4092 @cindex @command{mhl}
4093 @cindex @file{mhl.reply}
4094 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
4095 @cindex files, @file{mhl.reply}
4096 @cindex replying
4097 @findex mh-reply
4098 @kindex r
4099
4100 To compose a reply to a message, use the @kbd{r} (@code{mh-reply})
4101 command.
4102
4103 When you reply to a message, you are first prompted with @samp{Reply
4104 to whom?}. You have several choices here.
4105
4106 @quotation
4107 @multitable @columnfractions .20 .80
4108 @c @headitem Response @tab Reply Goes To
4109 @c XXX @headitem not yet supported by SourceForge's texi2pdf.
4110 @item @b{Response} @tab @b{Reply Goes To}
4111 @c -------------------------
4112 @item @kbd{from}
4113 @tab
4114 The person who sent the message. This is the default, so @key{RET} is
4115 sufficient.
4116 @c -------------------------
4117 @item @kbd{to}
4118 @tab
4119 Replies to the sender, plus all recipients in the @samp{To:} header field.
4120 @c -------------------------
4121 @item @kbd{cc}@*@kbd{all}
4122 @tab
4123 Forms a reply to the addresses in the @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header
4124 field if one exists; otherwise forms a reply to the sender, plus all
4125 recipients.
4126 @end multitable
4127 @end quotation
4128
4129 @cindex @command{repl}
4130 @cindex MH commands, @command{repl}
4131 @vindex mh-reply-default-reply-to
4132
4133 Depending on your answer, @command{repl}@footnote{See the section
4134 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reprep.html, Replying to Messages: repl} in
4135 the MH book.} is given a different argument to form your reply.
4136 Specifically, a choice of @kbd{from} or none at all runs @samp{repl
4137 -nocc all}, and a choice of @kbd{to} runs @samp{repl -cc to}. Finally,
4138 either @kbd{cc} or @kbd{all} runs @samp{repl -cc all -nocc me}. If you
4139 find that most of the time you specify one of these choices when you
4140 reply to a message, you can change the option
4141 @code{mh-reply-default-reply-to} from its default value of
4142 @samp{Prompt} to one of the choices listed above. You can always edit
4143 the recipients in the draft.
4144
4145 @cindex @samp{repl:} MH profile component
4146 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{repl:}
4147 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4148 @cindex MH-Show mode
4149 @cindex draft
4150 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4151 @cindex modes, MH-Show
4152
4153 Two windows are then created. One window contains the message to which
4154 you are replying in an MH-Show buffer. Your draft, in MH-Letter mode
4155 (@pxref{Editing Drafts}), is in the other window. If the reply draft
4156 was not one that you expected, check the things that affect the
4157 behavior of @command{repl} which include the @samp{repl:} profile
4158 component and the @file{replcomps} and @file{replgroupcomps} files.
4159
4160 If you supply a prefix argument (as in @kbd{C-u r}), the message you
4161 are replying to is inserted in your reply after having first been run
4162 through @command{mhl} with the format file @file{mhl.reply}. See
4163 @command{mhl}(1) or the section
4164 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in the MH
4165 book to see how you can modify the default @file{mhl.reply} file.
4166
4167 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4168
4169 Alternatively, you can customize the option @code{mh-yank-behavior}
4170 and choose one of its @samp{Automatically} variants to do the same
4171 thing. @xref{Inserting Letter}. If you do so, the prefix argument has
4172 no effect.
4173
4174 Another way to include the message automatically in your draft is to
4175 use @samp{repl: -filter repl.filter} in your MH profile.
4176
4177 @vindex mh-reply-show-message-flag
4178
4179 If you include the message automatically, you can hide the MH-Show
4180 buffer by turning off the option @code{mh-reply-show-message-flag}.
4181
4182 If you wish to customize the header or other parts of the reply draft,
4183 please see @command{repl}(1) and @code{mh-format}(5).
4184
4185 @node Forwarding, Redistributing, Replying, Sending Mail
4186 @section Forwarding Mail
4187
4188 @cindex @command{forw}
4189 @cindex draft
4190 @cindex forwarding
4191 @cindex MH commands, @command{forw}
4192 @findex mh-forward
4193 @kindex f
4194 @vindex mh-forward-hook
4195
4196 To forward a message, use the @kbd{f} (@code{mh-forward}) command. You
4197 are prompted for the @samp{To:} and @samp{cc:} recipients. You are
4198 given a draft to edit that looks like it would if you had run the MH
4199 command @command{forw}@footnote{See the section
4200 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/forfor.html, Forwarding Messages: forw} in
4201 the MH book.}. You can then add some text (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
4202 You can forward several messages by using a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
4203 All of the messages in the range are inserted into your draft. The
4204 hook @code{mh-forward-hook} is called on the draft.
4205
4206 @cindex @file{.mh_profile}
4207 @cindex files, @file{.mh_profile}
4208 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{forw:}
4209 @cindex @samp{forw:} MH profile component
4210 @vindex mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag
4211
4212 By default, the option @code{mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag} is on
4213 which means that the forwarded messages are included as attachments.
4214 If you would prefer to forward your messages verbatim (as text,
4215 inline), then turn off this option. Forwarding messages verbatim works
4216 well for short, textual messages, but your recipient won't be able to
4217 view any non-textual attachments that were in the forwarded message.
4218 Be aware that if you have @samp{forw: -mime} in your MH profile, then
4219 forwarded messages will always be included as attachments regardless
4220 of the settings of @code{mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag}.
4221
4222 @vindex mh-forward-subject-format
4223
4224 The format of the @samp{Subject:} header field for forwarded messages
4225 is controlled by the option @code{mh-forward-subject-format}. This
4226 option is a string which includes two escapes (@samp{%s}). The first
4227 @samp{%s} is replaced with the sender of the original message, and the
4228 second one is replaced with the original @samp{Subject:}. The default
4229 value of @code{"%s: %s"} takes a message with the header:
4230
4231 @smallexample
4232 @group
4233 To: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
4234 Subject: Re: 49er football
4235 From: Greg DesBrisay <gd@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
4236 @end group
4237 @end smallexample
4238
4239 and creates a subject header field of:
4240
4241 @smallexample
4242 Subject: Greg DesBrisay: Re: 49er football
4243 @end smallexample
4244
4245 @node Redistributing, Editing Again, Forwarding, Sending Mail
4246 @section Redistributing Your Mail
4247
4248 @cindex @command{dist}
4249 @cindex MH commands, @command{dist}
4250 @cindex redistributing
4251 @findex mh-redistribute
4252 @kindex M-d
4253
4254 The command @kbd{M-d} (@code{mh-redistribute}) is similar in function
4255 to forwarding mail, but it does not allow you to edit the message, nor
4256 does it add your name to the @samp{From:} header field. It appears to
4257 the recipient as if the message had come from the original sender.
4258 When you run this command, you are prompted for the recipients.
4259
4260 @findex mh-edit-again
4261 @kindex e
4262
4263 For more information on redistributing messages, see
4264 @command{dist}(1). Also investigate the command @kbd{e}
4265 (@code{mh-edit-again}) for another way to redistribute messages
4266 (@pxref{Editing Again}).
4267
4268 @cindex @command{send}
4269 @cindex MH commands, @command{send}
4270 @vindex mh-redist-full-contents-flag
4271
4272 The option @code{mh-redist-full-contents-flag} must be turned on if
4273 @command{dist}@footnote{See the section
4274 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/disdis.html, Distributing Messages with
4275 dist} in the MH book.} requires the whole letter for redistribution,
4276 which is the case if @command{send}@footnote{See the section
4277 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sensen.html, Sending Some Mail: comp send}
4278 in the MH book.} is compiled with the @sc{berk} option (which many
4279 people abhor). If you find that MH will not allow you to redistribute
4280 a message that has been redistributed before, turn off this option.
4281
4282 @node Editing Again, , Redistributing, Sending Mail
4283 @section Editing Old Drafts and Bounced Messages
4284
4285 @cindex @file{draft}
4286 @cindex files, @file{draft}
4287 @cindex re-editing drafts
4288 @findex mh-edit-again
4289 @kindex F v drafts
4290 @kindex e
4291 @kindex n
4292
4293 If you don't complete a draft for one reason or another, and if the
4294 draft buffer is no longer available, you can pick your draft up again
4295 with @kbd{e} (@code{mh-edit-again}). If you don't use a draft
4296 folder, your last @file{draft} file will be used. If you use draft
4297 folders, you'll need to visit the draft folder with @kbd{F v drafts
4298 @key{RET}}, use @kbd{n} to move to the appropriate message, and then
4299 use @kbd{e} to prepare the message for editing.
4300
4301 @kindex e
4302
4303 The @kbd{e} command can also be used to take messages that were sent
4304 to you and to send them to more people.
4305
4306 @cindex Mailer-Daemon
4307 @findex mh-extract-rejected-mail
4308 @kindex C-c C-c
4309 @kindex E
4310
4311 Don't use @kbd{e} to re-edit a message from a @i{Mailer-Daemon} who
4312 complained that your mail wasn't posted for some reason or another. In
4313 this case, use @kbd{E} (@code{mh-extract-rejected-mail}) to prepare
4314 the message for editing by removing the @i{Mailer-Daemon} envelope and
4315 unneeded header fields. Fix whatever addressing problem you had, and
4316 send the message again with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
4317
4318 @node Editing Drafts, Aliases, Sending Mail, Top
4319 @chapter Editing a Draft
4320
4321 @cindex @samp{Letter} menu
4322 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4323 @cindex draft
4324 @cindex editing draft
4325 @cindex menu, @samp{Letter}
4326 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4327
4328 When you edit a message that you want to send (called a @dfn{draft} in
4329 this case), the mode used is MH-Letter. This mode provides several
4330 commands in addition to the normal Emacs editing commands to help you
4331 edit your draft. These can also be found in the @samp{Letter} menu.
4332
4333 @table @kbd
4334 @kindex @key{SPC}
4335 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
4336 @item @key{SPC}
4337 Perform completion or insert space (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
4338 @c -------------------------
4339 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4340 @findex mh-letter-complete
4341 @item M-@key{TAB}
4342 Perform completion on header field or word preceding point
4343 (@code{mh-letter-complete}).
4344 @c -------------------------
4345 @kindex , (comma)
4346 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
4347 @item , (comma)
4348 Flash alias expansion (@code{mh-letter-confirm-address}).
4349 @c -------------------------
4350 @kindex @key{TAB}
4351 @findex mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent
4352 @item @key{TAB}
4353 Cycle to next field (@code{mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent}).
4354 @c -------------------------
4355 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
4356 @findex mh-letter-previous-header-field
4357 @item S-@key{TAB}
4358 Cycle to the previous header field
4359 (@code{mh-letter-previous-header-field}).
4360 @c -------------------------
4361 @kindex C-c ?
4362 @findex mh-help
4363 @item C-c ?
4364 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
4365 @c -------------------------
4366 @cindex @samp{Letter > Send This Draft} menu item
4367 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Send This Draft}
4368 @kindex C-c C-c
4369 @findex mh-send-letter
4370 @item C-c C-c
4371 Save draft and send message (@code{mh-send-letter}).
4372 @c -------------------------
4373 @kindex C-c C-d
4374 @findex mh-insert-identity
4375 @item C-c C-d
4376 Insert fields specified by the given identity
4377 (@code{mh-insert-identity}). @xref{Identities}.
4378 @c -------------------------
4379 @cindex @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MH)} menu item
4380 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MH)}
4381 @kindex C-c C-e
4382 @findex mh-mh-to-mime
4383 @item C-c C-e
4384 Compose @sc{mime} message from MH-style directives
4385 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}).
4386 @c -------------------------
4387 @kindex C-c C-f C-a
4388 @kindex C-c C-f a
4389 @findex mh-to-field
4390 @item C-c C-f C-a
4391 @itemx C-c C-f a
4392 Move to @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4393 @c -------------------------
4394 @kindex C-c C-f C-b
4395 @kindex C-c C-f b
4396 @item C-c C-f C-b
4397 @itemx C-c C-f b
4398 Move to @samp{Bcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4399 @c -------------------------
4400 @kindex C-c C-f C-c
4401 @kindex C-c C-f c
4402 @item C-c C-f C-c
4403 @itemx C-c C-f c
4404 Move to @samp{Cc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4405 @c -------------------------
4406 @kindex C-c C-f C-d
4407 @kindex C-c C-f d
4408 @item C-c C-f C-d
4409 @itemx C-c C-f d
4410 Move to @samp{Dcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4411 @c -------------------------
4412 @kindex C-c C-f C-f
4413 @kindex C-c C-f f
4414 @findex mh-to-fcc
4415 @item C-c C-f C-f
4416 @itemx C-c C-f f
4417 Move to @samp{Fcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-fcc}).
4418 @c -------------------------
4419 @kindex C-c C-f C-l
4420 @kindex C-c C-f l
4421 @item C-c C-f C-l
4422 @itemx C-c C-f l
4423 Move to @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4424 @c -------------------------
4425 @kindex C-c C-f C-m
4426 @kindex C-c C-f m
4427 @item C-c C-f C-m
4428 @itemx C-c C-f m
4429 Move to @samp{From:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4430 @c -------------------------
4431 @kindex C-c C-f C-r
4432 @kindex C-c C-f r
4433 @item C-c C-f C-r
4434 @itemx C-c C-f r
4435 Move to @samp{Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4436 @c -------------------------
4437 @kindex C-c C-f C-s
4438 @kindex C-c C-f s
4439 @item C-c C-f C-s
4440 @itemx C-c C-f s
4441 Move to @samp{Subject:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4442 @c -------------------------
4443 @kindex C-c C-f C-t
4444 @kindex C-c C-f t
4445 @item C-c C-f C-t
4446 @itemx C-c C-f t
4447 Move to @samp{To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4448 @c -------------------------
4449 @cindex @samp{Letter > Insert a Message...} menu item
4450 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Insert a Message...}
4451 @kindex C-c C-i
4452 @findex mh-insert-letter
4453 @item C-c C-i
4454 Insert a message (@code{mh-insert-letter}).
4455 @c -------------------------
4456 @kindex C-c C-m C-e
4457 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
4458 @item C-c C-m C-e
4459 Add tag to encrypt the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}).
4460 @c -------------------------
4461 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Forward...} menu item
4462 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Forward...}
4463 @kindex C-c C-m C-f
4464 @kindex C-c C-m f
4465 @findex mh-compose-forward
4466 @item C-c C-m C-f
4467 @itemx C-c C-m f
4468 Add tag to forward a message (@code{mh-compose-forward}).
4469 @c -------------------------
4470 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Get File (MH)...} menu item
4471 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Get File (MH)...}
4472 @kindex C-c C-m C-g
4473 @kindex C-c C-m g
4474 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
4475 @item C-c C-m C-g
4476 @itemx C-c C-m g
4477 Add tag to include anonymous ftp reference to a file
4478 (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}).
4479 @c -------------------------
4480 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Insertion...} menu item
4481 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Insertion...}
4482 @kindex C-c C-m C-i
4483 @kindex C-c C-m i
4484 @findex mh-compose-insertion
4485 @item C-c C-m C-i
4486 @itemx C-c C-m i
4487 Add tag to include a file such as an image or sound
4488 (@code{mh-compose-insertion}).
4489 @c -------------------------
4490 @cindex @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MML)} menu item
4491 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MML)}
4492 @kindex C-c C-m C-m
4493 @kindex C-c C-m m
4494 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
4495 @item C-c C-m C-m
4496 @itemx C-c C-m m
4497 Compose @sc{mime} message from MML tags (@code{mh-mml-to-mime}).
4498 @c -------------------------
4499 @kindex C-c C-m C-n
4500 @kindex C-c C-m n
4501 @findex mh-mml-unsecure-message
4502 @item C-c C-m C-n
4503 @itemx C-c C-m n
4504 Remove any secure message tags (@code{mh-mml-unsecure-message}).
4505 @c -------------------------
4506 @kindex C-c C-m C-s
4507 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
4508 @item C-c C-m C-s
4509 Add tag to sign the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign}).
4510 @c -------------------------
4511 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Compressed tar (MH)...} menu item
4512 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Compressed tar (MH)...}
4513 @kindex C-c C-m C-t
4514 @kindex C-c C-m t
4515 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar
4516 @item C-c C-m C-t
4517 @itemx C-c C-m t
4518 Add tag to include anonymous ftp reference to a compressed tar file
4519 (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar}).
4520 @c -------------------------
4521 @cindex @samp{Letter > Revert to Non-MIME Edit (MH)} menu item
4522 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Revert to Non-MIME Edit (MH)}
4523 @kindex C-c C-m C-u
4524 @kindex C-c C-m u
4525 @findex mh-mh-to-mime-undo
4526 @item C-c C-m C-u
4527 @itemx C-c C-m u
4528 Undo effects of @kbd{C-c C-e} (@code{mh-mh-to-mime-undo}).
4529 @c -------------------------
4530 @kindex C-c C-m C-x
4531 @kindex C-c C-m x
4532 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-type
4533 @item C-c C-m C-x
4534 @itemx C-c C-m x
4535 Add tag to refer to a remote file
4536 (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-type}).
4537 @c -------------------------
4538 @kindex C-c C-m e e
4539 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
4540 @item C-c C-m e e
4541 Add tag to encrypt the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}).
4542 @c -------------------------
4543 @kindex C-c C-m e s
4544 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
4545 @item C-c C-m e s
4546 Add tag to encrypt and sign the message@*
4547 (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}).
4548 @c -------------------------
4549 @kindex C-c C-m s e
4550 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
4551 @item C-c C-m s e
4552 Add tag to encrypt and sign the message@*
4553 (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}).
4554 @c -------------------------
4555 @kindex C-c C-m s s
4556 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
4557 @item C-c C-m s s
4558 Add tag to sign the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign}).
4559 @c -------------------------
4560 @cindex @samp{Letter > Split Current Line} menu item
4561 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Split Current Line}
4562 @kindex C-c C-o
4563 @findex mh-open-line
4564 @item C-c C-o
4565 Insert a newline and leave point before it (@code{mh-open-line}).
4566 @c -------------------------
4567 @cindex @samp{Letter > Kill This Draft} menu item
4568 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Kill This Draft}
4569 @kindex C-c C-q
4570 @findex mh-fully-kill-draft
4571 @item C-c C-q
4572 Quit editing and delete draft message (@code{mh-fully-kill-draft}).
4573 @c -------------------------
4574 @cindex @samp{Letter > Insert Signature} menu item
4575 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Insert Signature}
4576 @kindex C-c C-s
4577 @findex mh-insert-signature
4578 @item C-c C-s
4579 Insert signature in message (@code{mh-insert-signature}).
4580 @c -------------------------
4581 @kindex C-c C-t
4582 @findex mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display
4583 @item C-c C-t
4584 Toggle display of header field at point
4585 (@code{mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display}).
4586 @c -------------------------
4587 @cindex @samp{Letter > Check Recipient} menu item
4588 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Check Recipient}
4589 @kindex C-c C-w
4590 @findex mh-check-whom
4591 @item C-c C-w
4592 Verify recipients, showing expansion of any aliases
4593 (@code{mh-check-whom}).
4594 @c -------------------------
4595 @cindex @samp{Letter > Yank Current Message} menu item
4596 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Yank Current Message}
4597 @kindex C-c C-y
4598 @findex mh-yank-cur-msg
4599 @item C-c C-y
4600 Insert the current message into the draft buffer
4601 (@code{mh-yank-cur-msg}).
4602 @c -------------------------
4603 @kindex C-c M-d
4604 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
4605 @item C-c M-d
4606 Insert custom fields if recipient is found in
4607 @code{mh-auto-fields-list} (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}).
4608 @xref{Identities}.
4609 @end table
4610
4611 @cindex @samp{mh-letter} customization group
4612 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-letter}
4613
4614 Several options from the @samp{mh-letter} customization group are used
4615 while editing a draft.
4616
4617 @vtable @code
4618 @item mh-compose-insertion
4619 Type of @sc{mime} message tags in messages (default: @samp{MML} if
4620 available; otherwise @samp{MH}).
4621 @c -------------------------
4622 @item mh-compose-skipped-header-fields
4623 List of header fields to skip over when navigating in draft (default:
4624 @code{'("From"} @code{"Organization"} @code{"References"}
4625 @code{"In-Reply-To"} @code{"X-Face"} @code{"Face"}
4626 @code{"X-Image-URL"} @code{"X-Mailer")}.
4627 @c -------------------------
4628 @item mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag
4629 On means @key{SPC} does completion in message header (default:
4630 @samp{off}).
4631 @c -------------------------
4632 @item mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4633 On means delete any window displaying the message (default: @samp{off}).
4634 @c -------------------------
4635 @item mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4636 Verb to use for attribution when a message is yanked by @kbd{C-c C-y}
4637 (default: @code{"wrote:"}).
4638 @c -------------------------
4639 @item mh-ins-buf-prefix
4640 String to put before each line of a yanked or inserted message
4641 (default: @code{"> "}).
4642 @c -------------------------
4643 @item mh-letter-complete-function
4644 Function to call when completing outside of address or folder fields
4645 (default: @code{ispell-complete-word}).
4646 @c -------------------------
4647 @item mh-letter-fill-column
4648 Fill column to use in MH-Letter mode (default: 72).
4649 @c -------------------------
4650 @item mh-mml-method-default
4651 Default method to use in security tags (default: @samp{PGP (MIME)} if
4652 support for it is available; otherwise @samp{None}).
4653 @c -------------------------
4654 @item mh-signature-file-name
4655 Source of user's signature (default: @code{"~/.signature"}).
4656 @c -------------------------
4657 @item mh-signature-separator-flag
4658 On means a signature separator should be inserted (default:
4659 @samp{on}).
4660 @c -------------------------
4661 @item mh-x-face-file
4662 File containing X-Face or Face header field to insert in outgoing mail.
4663 (default: @code{"~/.face"}).
4664 @c -------------------------
4665 @item mh-yank-behavior
4666 Controls which part of a message is yanked by @kbd{C-c C-y} (default:
4667 @samp{Body With Attribution}).
4668 @end vtable
4669
4670 The following hooks are available.
4671
4672 @vtable @code
4673 @item mail-citation-hook
4674 Hook for modifying a citation just inserted in the mail buffer
4675 (default: @code{nil}).
4676 @c -------------------------
4677 @item mh-before-send-letter-hook
4678 Hook run at the beginning of the @kbd{C-c C-c} command (default:
4679 @samp{nil}).
4680 @c -------------------------
4681 @item mh-mh-to-mime-hook
4682 Hook run on the formatted letter by @kbd{C-c C-e} (default:
4683 @samp{nil}).
4684 @c -------------------------
4685 @item mh-insert-signature-hook
4686 Hook run by @kbd{C-c C-s} after signature has been inserted (default:
4687 @code{nil}).
4688 @end vtable
4689
4690 The following face is available.
4691
4692 @vtable @code
4693 @item mh-letter-header-field
4694 Editable header field value face in draft buffers.
4695 @end vtable
4696
4697 The commands and options introduced here are explained in more
4698 detail in the following sections.
4699
4700 @menu
4701 * Editing Message::
4702 * Inserting Letter::
4703 * Inserting Messages::
4704 * Signature::
4705 * Picture::
4706 * Adding Attachments::
4707 * Sending PGP::
4708 * Checking Recipients::
4709 * Sending Message::
4710 * Killing Draft::
4711 @end menu
4712
4713 @node Editing Message, Inserting Letter, Editing Drafts, Editing Drafts
4714 @section Editing the Message
4715
4716 @cindex @samp{Bcc:} header field
4717 @cindex @samp{Cc:} header field
4718 @cindex @samp{Dcc:} header field
4719 @cindex @samp{From:} header field
4720 @cindex @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field
4721 @cindex @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field
4722 @cindex @samp{Reply-To:} header field
4723 @cindex @samp{Subject:} header field
4724 @cindex @samp{To:} header field
4725 @cindex editing header
4726 @cindex header field, @samp{Bcc:}
4727 @cindex header field, @samp{Cc:}
4728 @cindex header field, @samp{Dcc:}
4729 @cindex header field, @samp{From:}
4730 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Followup-To:}
4731 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Reply-To:}
4732 @cindex header field, @samp{Reply-To:}
4733 @cindex header field, @samp{Subject:}
4734 @cindex header field, @samp{To:}
4735 @findex mh-to-field
4736 @kindex C-c C-f C-t
4737 @kindex C-c C-f t
4738
4739 Because the header is part of the message, you can edit the header
4740 fields as you wish. However, several convenience commands exist to
4741 help you create and edit them. For example, the command @kbd{C-c C-f
4742 C-t} (@code{mh-to-field}; alternatively, @kbd{C-c C-f t}) moves the
4743 cursor to the @samp{To:} header field, creating it if necessary. The
4744 commands for moving to the @samp{Cc:}, @samp{Subject:}, @samp{From:},
4745 @samp{Reply-To:}, @samp{Mail-Reply-To:}, @samp{Mail-Followup-To},
4746 @samp{Bcc:}, and @samp{Dcc:} header fields are similar.
4747
4748 @findex mh-to-fcc
4749 @kindex C-c C-f C-f
4750 @kindex C-c C-f f
4751
4752 One command behaves differently from the others, namely, @kbd{C-c C-f
4753 C-f} (@code{mh-to-fcc}; alternatively, @kbd{C-c C-f f}). This command
4754 will prompt you for the folder name in which to file a copy of the
4755 draft. @xref{Folder Selection}.
4756
4757 @findex indent-relative
4758 @findex mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent
4759 @findex mh-letter-previous-header-field
4760 @kindex @key{TAB}
4761 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
4762 @vindex mh-compose-skipped-header-fields
4763 @vindex mh-letter-header-field
4764
4765 Within the header of the message, the command@* @key{TAB}
4766 (@code{mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent}) moves between fields
4767 that are highlighted with the face @code{mh-letter-header-field},
4768 skipping those fields listed in
4769 @code{mh-compose-skipped-header-fields}. After the last field, this
4770 command then moves point to the message body before cycling back to
4771 the first field. If point is already past the first line of the
4772 message body, then this command indents by calling
4773 @code{indent-relative} with the given prefix argument. The command
4774 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-previous-header-field}) moves
4775 backwards between the fields and cycles to the body of the message
4776 after the first field. Unlike the command @key{TAB}, it will always
4777 take point to the last field from anywhere in the body.
4778
4779 @cindex alias completion
4780 @cindex completion
4781 @cindex spell check
4782 @findex ispell-complete-word
4783 @findex mh-letter-complete
4784 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
4785 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
4786 @kindex , (comma)
4787 @kindex @key{SPC}
4788 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4789 @vindex mh-alias-flash-on-comma
4790 @vindex mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag
4791 @vindex mh-letter-complete-function
4792
4793 If the field contains addresses (for example, @samp{To:} or
4794 @samp{Cc:}) or folders (for example, @samp{Fcc:}) then the command
4795 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) will provide alias
4796 completion (@pxref{Aliases}). In the body of the message,
4797 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} runs @code{mh-letter-complete-function} instead,
4798 which is set to @samp{'ispell-complete-word} by default. The command
4799 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) takes a prefix argument
4800 that is passed to the @code{mh-letter-complete-function}. In addition,
4801 turn on the option @code{mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag} to use
4802 the command @key{SPC} (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}) to perform
4803 completion in the header as well; use a prefix argument to specify
4804 more than one space. Addresses are separated by a comma; when you
4805 press the comma, the command @code{mh-letter-confirm-address} flashes
4806 the alias expansion in the minibuffer if
4807 @code{mh-alias-flash-on-comma} is turned on.
4808
4809 @c XXX Document the replacement for the inaccessible 'long argument.
4810
4811 @findex mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display
4812 @kindex C-c C-t
4813
4814 Use the command @kbd{C-c C-t}
4815 @code{mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display} to display truncated
4816 header fields. This command is a toggle so entering it again will hide
4817 the field. This command takes a prefix argument: if negative then the
4818 field is hidden, if positive then the field is displayed (for example,
4819 @kbd{C-u C-c C-t}).
4820
4821 Be sure to leave a row of dashes or a blank line between the header
4822 and the body of the message.
4823
4824 @vindex mh-letter-fill-column
4825
4826 The body of the message is edited as you would edit any Emacs buffer
4827 although there are a few commands and options to assist you. You can
4828 change the fill column in MH-Letter mode with the option
4829 @code{mh-letter-fill-column}. By default, this option is 72 to allow
4830 others to quote your message without line wrapping.
4831
4832 @cindex filling paragraphs
4833 @cindex paragraphs, filling
4834 @findex fill-paragraph
4835 @kindex M-q
4836 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4837
4838 You'll often include messages that were sent from user agents that
4839 haven't yet realized that paragraphs consist of more than a single
4840 line. This makes for long lines that wrap in an ugly fashion. You'll
4841 find that @kbd{M-q} (@code{fill-paragraph}) works well even on these
4842 quoted messages, even if they are nested, just as long as all of the
4843 quotes match the value of @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@pxref{Inserting
4844 Letter}). For example, let's assume you have the following in your
4845 draft:
4846
4847 @smallexample
4848 @group
4849 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm \
4850 not sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but \
4851 it's worked okay for me so far.
4852 @end group
4853 @end smallexample
4854
4855 Running @kbd{M-q} on this paragraph produces:
4856
4857 @smallexample
4858 @group
4859 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm not
4860 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4861 > worked okay for me so far.
4862 @end group
4863 @end smallexample
4864
4865 @findex mh-open-line
4866 @findex open-line
4867 @kindex C-c C-o
4868 @kindex C-o
4869
4870 The command @kbd{C-c C-o} (@code{mh-open-line}) is similar to the
4871 command @kbd{C-o} (@code{open-line}) in that it inserts a newline
4872 after point. It differs in that it also inserts the right number of
4873 quoting characters and spaces so that the next line begins in the same
4874 column as it was. This is useful when breaking up paragraphs in
4875 replies. For example, if this command was used when point was after
4876 the first period in the paragraph above, the result would be this:
4877
4878 @smallexample
4879 @group
4880 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing.
4881
4882 > I'm not
4883 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4884 > worked okay for me so far.
4885 @end group
4886 @end smallexample
4887
4888 @node Inserting Letter, Inserting Messages, Editing Message, Editing Drafts
4889 @section Inserting Letter to Which You're Replying
4890
4891 @cindex inserting messages
4892 @cindex replying to messages
4893 @cindex yanking messages
4894 @findex mh-yank-cur-msg
4895 @kindex C-c C-y
4896 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4897
4898 It is often useful to insert a snippet of text from a letter that
4899 someone mailed to provide some context for your reply. The command
4900 @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{mh-yank-cur-msg}) does this by adding an
4901 attribution, yanking a portion of text from the message to which
4902 you're replying, and inserting @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@samp{> })
4903 before each line.
4904
4905 @smallexample
4906 @group
4907 Michael W Thelen <thelenm@@stop.mail-abuse.org> wrote:
4908
4909 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm not
4910 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4911 > worked okay for me so far.
4912 @end group
4913 @end smallexample
4914
4915 @vindex mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4916
4917 The attribution consists of the sender's name and email address
4918 followed by the content of the option
4919 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. This option can be set to
4920 @samp{wrote:}, @samp{a écrit:}, and @samp{schrieb:}. You can also use
4921 the @samp{Custom String} menu item to enter your own verb.
4922
4923 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4924 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4925 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4926
4927 The prefix @code{"> "} is the default setting for the option
4928 @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix}. I suggest that you not modify this option
4929 since it is used by many mailers and news readers: messages are far
4930 easier to read if several included messages have all been indented by
4931 the same string. This prefix is not inserted if you use one of the
4932 supercite flavors of @code{mh-yank-behavior} or you have added a
4933 @code{mail-citation-hook} as described below.
4934
4935 @vindex mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4936
4937 You can also turn on the @code{mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag}
4938 option to delete the window containing the original message after
4939 yanking it to make more room on your screen for your reply.
4940
4941 @cindex Emacs, packages, supercite
4942 @cindex supercite package
4943 @kindex r
4944 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4945 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4946
4947 You can control how the message to which you are replying is yanked
4948 into your reply using @code{mh-yank-behavior}. To include the entire
4949 message, including the entire header, use @samp{Body and
4950 Header}@footnote{If you'd rather have the header cleaned up, use
4951 @kbd{C-u r} instead of @kbd{r} when replying
4952 (@pxref{Replying}).}@footnote{In the past you would use this setting
4953 and set @code{mail-citation-hook} to @samp{supercite}, but this usage
4954 is now deprecated in favor of the @samp{Invoke supercite} setting.}.
4955 Use @samp{Body} to yank just the body without the header. To yank only
4956 the portion of the message following the point, set this option to
4957 @samp{Below Point}.
4958
4959 Choose @samp{Invoke supercite}@footnote{@emph{Supercite} is a
4960 full-bodied, full-featured, citation package that comes standard with
4961 Emacs.} to pass the entire message and header through supercite.
4962
4963 @vindex mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4964
4965 If the @samp{Body With Attribution} setting is used, then the message
4966 minus the header is yanked and a simple attribution line is added at
4967 the top using the value of the option
4968 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. This is the default.
4969
4970 @kindex C-c C-y
4971 @vindex mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4972
4973 If the @samp{Invoke supercite} or @samp{Body With Attribution}
4974 settings are used, the @samp{-noformat} argument is passed to the
4975 @command{repl} program to override a @samp{-filter} or @samp{-format}
4976 argument. These settings also have @samp{Automatically} variants that
4977 perform the action automatically when you reply so that you don't need
4978 to use @kbd{C-c C-y} at all. Note that this automatic action is only
4979 performed if the show buffer matches the message being replied to.
4980 People who use the automatic variants tend to turn on the option
4981 @code{mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag} as well so that the show
4982 window is never displayed.
4983
4984 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4985
4986 If the show buffer has a region, the option @code{mh-yank-behavior} is
4987 ignored unless its value is one of @samp{Attribution} variants in
4988 which case the attribution is added to the yanked region.
4989
4990 @findex trivial-cite
4991 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4992 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4993 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4994
4995 If this isn't enough, you can gain full control over the appearance of
4996 the included text by setting @code{mail-citation-hook} to a function
4997 that modifies it. This hook is ignored if the option
4998 @code{mh-yank-behavior} is set to one of the supercite flavors.
4999 Otherwise, this option controls how much of the message is passed to
5000 the hook. The function can find the citation between point and mark
5001 and it should leave point and mark around the modified citation text
5002 for the next hook function. The standard prefix
5003 @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} is not added if this hook is set.
5004
5005 @cindex Emacs, packages, trivial-cite
5006 @cindex trivial-cite package
5007 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
5008
5009 For example, if you use the hook function
5010 @uref{http://shasta.cs.uiuc.edu/~lrclause/tc.html,
5011 @code{trivial-cite}} (which is NOT part of Emacs), set
5012 @code{mh-yank-behavior} to @samp{Body and Header}.
5013
5014 @node Inserting Messages, Signature, Inserting Letter, Editing Drafts
5015 @section Inserting Messages
5016
5017 @cindex inserting messages
5018 @findex mh-insert-letter
5019 @findex mh-yank-behavior
5020 @kindex C-c C-i
5021 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
5022 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields-compiled
5023 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
5024
5025 Messages can be inserted with @kbd{C-c C-i} (@code{mh-insert-letter}).
5026 This command prompts you for the folder and message number, which
5027 defaults to the current message in that folder. It then inserts the
5028 messages, indented by @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@samp{> }) unless
5029 @code{mh-yank-behavior} is set to one of the supercite flavors in
5030 which case supercite is used to format the message. Certain
5031 undesirable header fields (see
5032 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields-compiled}) are removed before
5033 insertion.
5034
5035 If given a prefix argument (like @kbd{C-u C-c C-i}), the header is
5036 left intact, the message is not indented, and @samp{> } is not
5037 inserted before each line. This command leaves the mark before the
5038 letter and point after it.
5039
5040 @node Signature, Picture, Inserting Messages, Editing Drafts
5041 @section Inserting Your Signature
5042
5043 @cindex signature
5044 @findex mh-insert-signature
5045 @kindex C-c C-s
5046
5047 You can insert your signature at the current cursor location with the
5048 command @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{mh-insert-signature}).
5049
5050 @cindex files, @file{.signature}
5051 @cindex @file{.signature}
5052 @cindex vCard
5053 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5054
5055 By default, the text of your signature is taken from the file
5056 @file{~/.signature}. You can read from other sources by changing the
5057 option @code{mh-signature-file-name}. This file may contain a
5058 @dfn{vCard} in which case an attachment is added with the vCard.
5059
5060 @findex mh-signature-separator-p
5061 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5062 @vindex mh-signature-separator
5063 @vindex mh-signature-separator-regexp
5064
5065 The option @code{mh-signature-file-name} may also be a symbol, in
5066 which case that function is called. You may not want a signature
5067 separator to be added for you; instead you may want to insert one
5068 yourself. Options that you may find useful to do this include
5069 @code{mh-signature-separator} (when inserting a signature separator)
5070 and @code{mh-signature-separator-regexp} (for finding said separator).
5071 The function @code{mh-signature-separator-p}, which reports @code{t}
5072 if the buffer contains a separator, may be useful as well.
5073
5074 @cindex signature separator
5075 @vindex mh-signature-separator-flag
5076
5077 A signature separator (@code{"-- "}) will be added if the signature
5078 block does not contain one and @code{mh-signature-separator-flag} is
5079 on. It is not recommended that you change this option since various
5080 mail user agents, including MH-E, use the separator to present the
5081 signature differently, and to suppress the signature when replying or
5082 yanking a letter into a draft.
5083
5084 @vindex mh-insert-signature-hook
5085 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5086
5087 The hook @code{mh-insert-signature-hook} is run after the signature is
5088 inserted. Hook functions may access the actual name of the file or the
5089 function used to insert the signature with
5090 @code{mh-signature-file-name}.
5091
5092 The signature can also be inserted using Identities.
5093 @xref{Identities}.
5094
5095 @node Picture, Adding Attachments, Signature, Editing Drafts
5096 @section Inserting Your Picture
5097
5098 @cindex @file{.face}
5099 @cindex files, @file{.face}
5100 @vindex mh-x-face-file
5101
5102 You can insert your picture in the header of your mail message so that
5103 recipients see your face in the @samp{From:} header field if their
5104 mail user agent is sophisticated enough. In MH-E, this is done by
5105 placing your image in the file named by the option
5106 @code{mh-x-face-file} which is @file{~/.face} by default.
5107
5108 @cindex @samp{Face:} header field
5109 @cindex @samp{X-Face:} header field
5110 @cindex @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field
5111 @cindex header field, @samp{Face:}
5112 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Face:}
5113 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Image-URL:}
5114
5115 If the file starts with either of the strings @samp{X-Face:},
5116 @samp{Face:} or @samp{X-Image-URL:} then the contents are added to the
5117 message header verbatim. Otherwise it is assumed that the file
5118 contains the value of the @samp{X-Face:} header field.
5119
5120 @cindex @command{compface}
5121 @cindex Unix commands, @command{compface}
5122
5123 The @samp{X-Face:} header field, which is a low-resolution, black and
5124 white image, can be generated using the
5125 @uref{ftp://ftp.cs.indiana.edu/pub/faces/compface/compface.tar.Z,
5126 @command{compface}} command. The @uref{http://www.dairiki.org/xface/,
5127 @cite{Online X-Face Converter}} is a useful resource for quick
5128 conversion of images into @samp{X-Face:} header fields.
5129
5130 Use the @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/make-face,
5131 @command{make-face}} script to convert a JPEG image to the higher
5132 resolution, color, @samp{Face:} header field.
5133
5134 The URL of any image can be used for the @samp{X-Image-URL:} field and
5135 no processing of the image is required.
5136
5137 @vindex mh-x-face-file
5138
5139 To prevent the setting of any of these header fields, either set
5140 @code{mh-x-face-file} to @code{nil}, or simply ensure that the file
5141 defined by this option doesn't exist.
5142
5143 @xref{Viewing}, to see how these header fields are displayed in MH-E.
5144
5145 @node Adding Attachments, Sending PGP, Picture, Editing Drafts
5146 @section Adding Attachments
5147
5148 @cindex @command{mhbuild}
5149 @cindex @command{mhn}
5150 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhbuild}
5151 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
5152 @cindex MIME
5153 @cindex multimedia mail
5154
5155 MH-E has the capability to create multimedia messages. It uses the
5156 @sc{mime} (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions)
5157 protocol@footnote{@sc{mime} is defined in
5158 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2045.txt, RFC 2045}.} The
5159 @sc{mime} protocol allows you to incorporate images, sound, video,
5160 binary files, and even commands that fetch a file with @samp{ftp} when
5161 your recipient reads the message!
5162
5163 @kindex C-c C-m
5164
5165 If you were to create a multimedia message with plain MH commands, you
5166 would insert @command{mhbuild} or @command{mhn} directives (henceforth
5167 called @dfn{MH-style directives} into your draft and use the
5168 @command{mhbuild} command in nmh or @command{mhn} command in MH and
5169 GNU mailutils to expand them. MH-E works in much the same way,
5170 although it provides a handful of commands prefixed with @kbd{C-c C-m}
5171 to insert the directives so you don't need to remember the syntax of
5172 them. Remember: you can always add MH-style directives by
5173 hand@footnote{See the section
5174 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#SeMIMa, Sending MIME Mail} in
5175 the MH book.}.
5176
5177 @cindex MIME Meta Language (MML)
5178 @cindex MML
5179 @vindex mh-compose-insertion
5180
5181 In addition to MH-style directives, MH-E also supports MML (@sc{mime}
5182 Meta Language) tags@footnote{
5183 @ifinfo
5184 @c Although the third argument should default to the
5185 @c first, makeinfo goes to the wrong Info file without it being
5186 @c different--it seems to be getting our own Composing node.
5187 @xref{Composing,,Composing with MML,emacs-mime}.
5188 @end ifinfo
5189 @ifnotinfo
5190 See the section Composing in
5191 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/emacs-mime.html, @cite{The Emacs MIME
5192 Manual}}.
5193 @end ifnotinfo
5194 }. The option @code{mh-compose-insertion} can be used to choose
5195 between them. By default, this option is set to @samp{MML} if it is
5196 supported since it provides a lot more functionality. This option can
5197 also be set to @samp{MH} if MH-style directives are preferred.
5198
5199 @cindex media types
5200 @cindex MIME, media types
5201
5202 The MH-E @sc{mime} commands require a @dfn{media type} for each body
5203 part or attachment. For example, a PDF document is of type
5204 @samp{application/pdf} and an HTML document is of type
5205 @samp{text/html}. Some commands fill in the media type for you,
5206 whereas others require you to enter one.
5207
5208 @cindex @command{file}
5209 @cindex @file{/etc/mime.types}
5210 @cindex files, @file{/etc/mime.types}
5211 @cindex Unix commands, @command{file}
5212 @findex mailcap-mime-types
5213
5214 In the cases where MH-E can do so, it will determine the media type
5215 automatically. It uses the @command{file} command to do this. Failing
5216 that, the Emacs function @code{mailcap-mime-types} is used to provide
5217 a list from which to choose. This function usually reads the file
5218 @file{/etc/mime.types}.
5219
5220 Whether the media type is chosen automatically, or you choose it from
5221 a list, use the type that seems to match best the file that you are
5222 including. In the case of binaries, the media type
5223 @samp{application/x-executable} can be useful. If you can't find an
5224 appropriate media type, use @samp{text/plain} for text messages and
5225 @samp{application/octet-stream} for everything else.
5226
5227 @cindex content description
5228 @cindex MIME, content description
5229
5230 You are also sometimes asked for a @dfn{content description}. This is
5231 simply an optional brief phrase, in your own words, that describes the
5232 object. If you don't care to enter a content description, just press
5233 return and none will be included; however, a reader may skip over
5234 multimedia fields unless the content description is compelling.
5235
5236 You can also create your own @sc{mime} body parts. In the following
5237 example, I describe how you can create and edit a @samp{text/enriched}
5238 body part to liven up your plain text messages with boldface,
5239 underlining, and italics. I include an Emacs function which inserts
5240 enriched text tags.
5241
5242 @smalllisp
5243 @group
5244 (defvar enriched-text-types '(("b" . "bold") ("i" . "italic")
5245 ("u" . "underline")
5246 ("s" . "smaller") ("B" . "bigger")
5247 ("f" . "fixed")
5248 ("c" . "center"))
5249 "Alist of (final-character . tag) choices for add-enriched-text.
5250 Additional types can be found in RFC 1563.")
5251
5252 (defun add-enriched-text (begin end)
5253 "Add enriched text tags around region.
5254 The tag used comes from the list enriched-text-types and is
5255 specified by the last keystroke of the command. When called from Lisp,
5256 arguments are BEGIN and END@."
5257 (interactive "r")
5258 ;; @r{Set type to the tag indicated by the last keystroke.}
5259 (let ((type (cdr (assoc (char-to-string (logior last-input-char ?@w{`}))
5260 enriched-text-types))))
5261 (save-restriction ; @r{restores state from narrow-to-region}
5262 (narrow-to-region begin end) ; @r{narrow view to region}
5263 (goto-char (point-min)) ; @r{move to beginning of text}
5264 (insert "<" type ">") ; @r{insert beginning tag}
5265 (goto-char (point-max)) ; @r{move to end of text}
5266 (insert "</" type ">")))) ; @r{insert terminating tag}
5267 @i{Emacs function for entering enriched text}
5268
5269 @end group
5270 @end smalllisp
5271
5272 To use the function @code{add-enriched-text}, first add it to
5273 @file{~/.emacs} and create key bindings for it (@pxref{Composing}).
5274
5275 Then, in your plain text message, set the mark with @kbd{C-@@} or
5276 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, type in the text to be highlighted, and type @kbd{C-c t
5277 b}. This adds @samp{<bold>} where you set the mark and adds
5278 @samp{</bold>} at the location of your cursor, giving you something
5279 like: @samp{You should be <bold>very</bold>}.
5280
5281 Before sending this message, use @kbd{C-c C-m C-m}
5282 (@code{mh-mml-to-mime})@footnote{Use @kbd{C-c C-e}
5283 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}) if you're using MH-style directives.} to add
5284 MIME header fields. Then replace @samp{text/plain} with
5285 @samp{text/enriched} in the @samp{Content-Type:} header field.
5286
5287 You may also be interested in investigating @code{sgml-mode}.
5288
5289 @subheading Including Files
5290
5291 @cindex attachments, inserting
5292 @cindex images
5293 @cindex MIME, images
5294 @cindex MIME, sound
5295 @cindex MIME, video
5296 @cindex sound
5297 @cindex video
5298 @findex mh-compose-insertion
5299 @kindex C-c C-m C-i
5300 @kindex C-c C-m i
5301 @vindex mh-compose-insertion
5302
5303 Binaries, images, sound, and video can be inserted in your message
5304 with the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-i} (@code{mh-compose-insertion}). You
5305 are prompted for the filename containing the object, the media type if
5306 it cannot be determined automatically, and a content description. If
5307 you're using MH-style directives, you will also be prompted for
5308 additional attributes.
5309
5310 @subheading Forwarding Multimedia Messages
5311
5312 @findex mh-compose-forward
5313 @kindex C-c C-m C-f
5314 @kindex C-c C-m f
5315
5316 Mail may be forwarded with @sc{mime} using the command @kbd{C-c C-m
5317 C-f} (@code{mh-compose-forward}). You are prompted for a content
5318 description, the name of the folder in which the messages to forward
5319 are located, and a range of messages, which defaults to the current
5320 message in that folder. @xref{Ranges}.
5321
5322 @subheading Including an FTP Reference
5323
5324 @cindex @command{ftp}
5325 @cindex MIME, @command{ftp}
5326 @cindex Unix commands, @command{ftp}
5327 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
5328 @kindex C-c C-m C-g
5329 @kindex C-c C-m g
5330
5331 You can have your message initiate an @command{ftp} transfer when the
5332 recipient reads the message. To do this, use the command @kbd{C-c C-m
5333 C-g} (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}). You are prompted for the remote
5334 host and filename, the media type, and the content description.
5335
5336 @subheading Including tar Files
5337
5338 @cindex @command{ftp}
5339 @cindex @command{tar}
5340 @cindex MIME, @command{ftp}
5341 @cindex MIME, @command{tar}
5342 @cindex Unix commands, @command{ftp}
5343 @cindex Unix commands, @command{tar}
5344 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
5345 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar
5346 @kindex C-c C-m C-g
5347 @kindex C-c C-m C-t
5348 @kindex C-c C-m t
5349
5350 If the remote file is a compressed tar file, you can use @kbd{C-c C-m
5351 C-t} (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar}). Then, in addition
5352 to retrieving the file via anonymous @emph{ftp} as per the command
5353 @kbd{C-c C-m C-g} (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}), the file will also
5354 be uncompressed and untarred. You are prompted for the remote host and
5355 filename and the content description.
5356
5357 @subheading Including Other External Files
5358
5359 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-type
5360 @kindex C-c C-m C-x
5361 @kindex C-c C-m x
5362
5363 The command @kbd{C-c C-m C-x} (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-type}) is
5364 a general utility for referencing external files. In fact, all of the
5365 other commands that insert tags to access external files call this
5366 command. You are prompted for the access type, remote host and
5367 filename, and content type. If you provide a prefix argument, you are
5368 also prompted for a content description, attributes, parameters, and a
5369 comment.
5370
5371 @subheading Previewing Multimedia Messages
5372
5373 When you are finished editing a @sc{mime} message, it might look like this:
5374
5375 @cartouche
5376 @smallexample
5377 3 t08/24 root received fax files on Wed Aug 24 11:00:
5378 4+t08/24 To:wohler Test<<This is a test message to get the
5379
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384 --:%% @{+inbox@} 4 msgs (1-4) Bot L4 (MH-Folder Show)---------------
5385 To: wohler
5386 cc:
5387 Subject: Test of MIME
5388 --------
5389 Here is the SETI@@Home logo:
5390
5391 <#part type="image/x-xpm" filename="~/lib/images/setiathome.xpm"
5392 disposition=inline description="SETI@@home logo">
5393 <#/part>
5394 --:** @{draft@} All L8 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
5395
5396 @end smallexample
5397 @end cartouche
5398 @i{MH-E @sc{mime} draft}
5399
5400 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
5401 @kindex C-c C-m C-m
5402 @kindex C-c C-m m
5403
5404 Typically, you send a message with attachments just like any other
5405 message (@pxref{Sending Message}).
5406
5407 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
5408 @kindex C-c C-m C-m
5409
5410 However, you may take a sneak preview of the @sc{mime} encoding if you
5411 wish by running the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-m} (@code{mh-mml-to-mime}).
5412 The following screen shows the @sc{mime} encoding specified by the
5413 tags. You can see why mail user agents are usually built to hide these
5414 details from the user.
5415
5416 @cartouche
5417 @smallexample
5418 To: wohler
5419 cc:
5420 Subject: Test of MIME
5421 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
5422 MIME-Version: 1.0
5423 Content-Type: multipart/mixed; boundary="=-=-="
5424 --------
5425 --=-=-=
5426
5427 Here is the SETI@@Home logo:
5428
5429
5430 --=-=-=
5431 Content-Type: image/x-xpm
5432 Content-Disposition: inline; filename=setiathome.xpm
5433 Content-Transfer-Encoding: base64
5434 Content-Description: SETI@@home logo
5435
5436 LyogWFBNICovCnN0YXRpYyBjaGFyICogc2V0aWF0aG9tZV94cG1bXSA9IHsKIjQ1IDQ1IDc2N
5437 --:-- @{draft@} Top L1 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
5438
5439 @end smallexample
5440 @end cartouche
5441 @i{MH-E @sc{mime} draft ready to send}
5442
5443 @cindex undo effects of mh-mml-to-mime
5444
5445 This action can be undone by running @kbd{C-_} (@code{undo}).
5446
5447 @cindex @command{mhbuild}
5448 @cindex @command{mhn}
5449 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhbuild}
5450 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
5451 @cindex undo effects of mh-mh-to-mime
5452 @findex mh-mh-to-mime
5453 @findex mh-mh-to-mime-undo
5454 @kindex C-c C-e
5455 @kindex C-c C-m C-m
5456 @kindex C-c C-m C-u
5457 @kindex C-c C-m u
5458
5459 If you're using MH-style directives, use @kbd{C-c C-e}
5460 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}) instead of @kbd{C-c C-m C-m}. This runs the
5461 command @command{mhbuild} (@command{mhn}) on the message which expands
5462 the tags@footnote{See the section
5463 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#SeMIMa, Sending MIME Mail} in
5464 the MH book.}. This action can be undone by running @kbd{C-c C-m C-u}
5465 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime-undo}), which works by reverting to a backup
5466 file. You are prompted to confirm this action, but you can avoid the
5467 confirmation by adding an argument (for example, @kbd{C-u C-c C-m
5468 C-u}).
5469
5470 @kindex C-c C-e
5471 @vindex mh-mh-to-mime-args
5472
5473 If you wish to pass additional arguments to @command{mhbuild}
5474 (@command{mhn}) to affect how it builds your message, use the option
5475 @code{mh-mh-to-mime-args}. For example, you can build a consistency
5476 check into the message by setting @code{mh-mh-to-mime-args} to
5477 @samp{-check}. The recipient of your message can then run
5478 @samp{mhbuild -check} on the message---@command{mhbuild}
5479 (@command{mhn}) will complain if the message has been corrupted on the
5480 way. The command @kbd{C-c C-e} only consults this option when given a
5481 prefix argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-e}).
5482
5483 @kindex C-c C-e
5484 @vindex mh-mh-to-mime-hook
5485
5486 The hook @code{mh-mh-to-mime-hook} is called after the message has
5487 been formatted by @kbd{C-c C-e}.
5488
5489 @node Sending PGP, Checking Recipients, Adding Attachments, Editing Drafts
5490 @section Signing and Encrypting Messages
5491
5492 @cindex signing messages
5493 @cindex encrypting messages
5494 @cindex RFC 3156
5495
5496 MH-E can sign and encrypt messages as defined in
5497 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3156.txt, RFC 3156}. If you
5498 should choose to sign or encrypt your message, use one of the
5499 following commands to do so any time before sending your message.
5500
5501 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
5502 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
5503 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
5504 @kindex C-c C-m C-e
5505 @kindex C-c C-m C-s
5506 @kindex C-c C-m e e
5507 @kindex C-c C-m e s
5508 @kindex C-c C-m s e
5509 @kindex C-c C-m s s
5510
5511 The command @kbd{C-c C-m C-s} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign})
5512 inserts the following tag:
5513
5514 @smallexample
5515 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=sign>
5516 @end smallexample
5517
5518 This is used to sign your message digitally. Likewise, the command
5519 @kbd{C-c C-m C-e} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}) inserts the
5520 following tag:
5521
5522 @smallexample
5523 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=encrypt>
5524 @end smallexample
5525
5526 This is used to encrypt your message. Finally, the command @kbd{C-c
5527 C-m s e} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}) inserts the
5528 following tag:
5529
5530 @smallexample
5531 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=signencrypt>
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @findex mh-mml-unsecure-message
5535 @kindex C-c C-m C-n
5536 @kindex C-c C-m n
5537 @vindex mh-mml-method-default
5538
5539 This is used to sign and encrypt your message. In each of these cases,
5540 a proper multipart message is created for you when you send the
5541 message. Use the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-n}
5542 (@code{mh-mml-unsecure-message}) to remove these tags. Use a prefix
5543 argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-m s e}) to be prompted for one of the
5544 possible security methods (see @code{mh-mml-method-default}).
5545
5546 @vindex mh-mml-method-default
5547
5548 The option @code{mh-mml-method-default} is used to select between a
5549 variety of mail security mechanisms. The default is @samp{PGP (MIME)}
5550 if it is supported; otherwise, the default is @samp{None}. Other
5551 mechanisms include vanilla @samp{PGP} and @samp{S/MIME}.
5552
5553 @cindex @samp{pgg} customization group
5554 @cindex PGG
5555 @cindex customization group, @samp{pgg}
5556
5557 The @samp{pgg} customization group may have some settings which may
5558 interest you.
5559 @iftex
5560 See @cite{The PGG Manual}.
5561 @end iftex
5562 @ifinfo
5563 @xref{Top, , The PGG Manual, pgg, The PGG Manual}.
5564 @end ifinfo
5565 @ifhtml
5566 See
5567 @uref{http://www.dk.xemacs.org/Documentation/packages/html/pgg.html,
5568 @cite{The PGG Manual}}.
5569 @end ifhtml
5570
5571 @cindex header field, @samp{Fcc:}
5572 @cindex @samp{Fcc:} header field
5573 @vindex pgg-encrypt-for-me
5574
5575 In particular, I turn on the option @code{pgg-encrypt-for-me} so that
5576 all messages I encrypt are encrypted with my public key as well. If
5577 you keep a copy of all of your outgoing mail with a @samp{Fcc:} header
5578 field, this setting is vital so that you can read the mail you write!
5579
5580 @node Checking Recipients, Sending Message, Sending PGP, Editing Drafts
5581 @section Checking Recipients
5582
5583 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
5584 @cindex @command{whom}
5585 @cindex MH commands, @command{whom}
5586 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
5587 @cindex checking recipients
5588 @cindex recipients, checking
5589 @findex mh-check-whom
5590 @kindex C-c C-w
5591
5592 The command @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{mh-check-whom}) expands aliases so
5593 you can check the actual address(es) in the alias. A new buffer named
5594 @samp{*MH-E Recipients*} is created with the output of @command{whom}
5595 (@pxref{Miscellaneous})@footnote{See the section
5596 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/senove.html#WhaPro, What now? -- and the
5597 whatnow Program} in the MH book.}.
5598
5599 @node Sending Message, Killing Draft, Checking Recipients, Editing Drafts
5600 @section Sending a Message
5601
5602 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
5603 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
5604 @cindex sending mail
5605 @findex mh-send-letter
5606 @kindex C-c C-c
5607
5608 When you are all through editing a message, you send it with the
5609 command @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{mh-send-letter}). You can give a prefix
5610 argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}) to monitor the first stage of the
5611 delivery; this output can be found in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Mail
5612 Delivery*} (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).
5613
5614 @cindex sending mail
5615 @cindex spell check
5616 @findex ispell-message
5617 @kindex C-c C-c
5618 @vindex mh-before-send-letter-hook
5619
5620 The hook @code{mh-before-send-letter-hook} is run at the beginning of
5621 the command @kbd{C-c C-c}. For example, if you want to check your
5622 spelling in your message before sending, add the function
5623 @code{ispell-message}.
5624
5625 @cindex @command{send}
5626 @cindex MH commands, @command{send}
5627 @vindex mh-send-prog
5628
5629 In case the MH @command{send} program@footnote{See the section
5630 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sensen.html, Sending Some Mail: comp send}
5631 in the MH book.} is installed under a different name, use
5632 @code{mh-send-prog} to tell MH-E the name.
5633
5634 @node Killing Draft, , Sending Message, Editing Drafts
5635 @section Killing the Draft
5636
5637 @cindex killing draft
5638 @findex kill-buffer
5639 @findex mh-fully-kill-draft
5640 @kindex C-c C-q
5641 @kindex C-x k
5642
5643 If for some reason you are not happy with the draft, you can use the
5644 command @kbd{C-c C-q} (@code{mh-fully-kill-draft}) to kill the draft
5645 buffer and delete the draft message. Use the command @kbd{C-x k}
5646 (@code{kill-buffer}) if you don't want to delete the draft message.
5647
5648 @node Aliases, Identities, Editing Drafts, Top
5649 @chapter Aliases
5650
5651 @cindex aliases
5652
5653 MH aliases are used in the same way in MH-E as they are in MH. Any
5654 alias listed as a recipient will be expanded when the message is sent.
5655 This chapter discusses other things you can do with aliases in MH-E.
5656
5657 @cindex MH-Letter mode
5658 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
5659
5660 The following commands are available in MH-Letter mode with the
5661 exception of @code{mh-alias-reload} which can be called from anywhere.
5662
5663 @table @kbd
5664 @kindex @key{SPC}
5665 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
5666 @item @key{SPC}
5667 Perform completion or insert space (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
5668 @c -------------------------
5669 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
5670 @findex mh-letter-complete
5671 @item M-@key{TAB}
5672 Perform completion on header field or word preceding point
5673 (@code{mh-letter-complete}).
5674 @c -------------------------
5675 @findex mh-alias-apropos
5676 @item mh-alias-apropos
5677 Show all aliases or addresses that match a regular expression.
5678 @c -------------------------
5679 @findex mh-alias-grab-from-field
5680 @item mh-alias-grab-from-field
5681 Add alias for the sender of the current message
5682 @c -------------------------
5683 @findex mh-alias-reload
5684 @item mh-alias-reload
5685 Reload MH aliases.
5686 @end table
5687
5688 @cindex @samp{mh-alias} customization group
5689 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-alias}
5690
5691 The @samp{mh-alias} customization group contains options associated
5692 with aliases.
5693
5694 @vtable @code
5695 @item mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag
5696 On means don't consider case significant in MH alias completion
5697 (default: @samp{on}).
5698 @c -------------------------
5699 @item mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag
5700 On means to expand aliases entered in the minibuffer (default:
5701 @samp{off}).
5702 @c -------------------------
5703 @item mh-alias-flash-on-comma
5704 Specify whether to flash address or warn on translation (default: @samp{Flash
5705 but Don't Warn If No Alias}).
5706 @c -------------------------
5707 @item mh-alias-insert-file
5708 Filename used to store a new MH-E alias (default: @samp{Use Aliasfile
5709 Profile Component}).
5710 @c -------------------------
5711 @item mh-alias-insertion-location
5712 Specifies where new aliases are entered in alias files (default:
5713 @samp{Alphabetical}).
5714 @c -------------------------
5715 @item mh-alias-local-users
5716 If @samp{on}, local users are added to alias completion (default:
5717 @samp{on}).
5718 @c -------------------------
5719 @item mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5720 String prefixed to the real names of users from the password file
5721 (default: @code{"local."}.
5722 @c -------------------------
5723 @item mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag
5724 On means the GECOS field in the password file uses a comma separator
5725 (default: @samp{on}).
5726 @end vtable
5727
5728 The following hook is available.
5729
5730 @vtable @code
5731 @item mh-alias-reloaded-hook
5732 Hook run by @code{mh-alias-reload} after loading aliases (default:
5733 @code{nil}).
5734 @end vtable
5735
5736 @subheading Adding Addresses to Draft
5737
5738 You can use aliases when you are adding recipients to a message.
5739
5740 @findex minibuffer-complete
5741 @kindex @key{TAB}
5742 @vindex mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag
5743 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
5744
5745 In order to use minibuffer prompting for recipients and the subject
5746 line in the minibuffer, turn on the option
5747 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag} (@pxref{Composing}), and use the
5748 @key{TAB} (@code{minibuffer-complete}) command to complete aliases
5749 (and optionally local logins) when prompted for the recipients. Turn
5750 on the option @code{mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag} if you want these
5751 aliases to be expanded to their respective addresses in the draft.
5752
5753 @findex mh-letter-complete
5754 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
5755 @kindex @key{SPC}
5756 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
5757
5758 Otherwise, you can complete aliases in the header of the draft with
5759 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) or @key{SPC}
5760 (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
5761
5762 @vindex mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag
5763
5764 As MH ignores case in the aliases, so too does MH-E. However, you may
5765 turn off the option @code{mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag} to
5766 make case significant which can be used to segregate completion of
5767 your aliases. You might use uppercase for mailing lists and lowercase
5768 for people. For example, you might have:
5769
5770 @smallexample
5771 mark.baushke: Mark Baushke <mdb@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
5772 MH-E: MH-E Mailing List <mh-e-devel@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 When this option is turned off, if you were to type @kbd{M} in the
5776 @samp{To:} field and then @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}, then you'd get the list;
5777 if you started with @kbd{m} and then entered @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}, then
5778 you'd get Mark's address. Note that this option affects completion
5779 only. If you were to enter @kbd{Mark.Baushke}, it would still be
5780 identified with your @samp{mark.baushke} alias.
5781
5782 @findex mh-alias-minibuffer-confirm-address
5783 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
5784 @vindex mh-alias-flash-on-comma
5785 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
5786
5787 To verify that the alias you've entered is valid, the alias will be
5788 displayed in the minibuffer when you type a comma
5789 (@code{mh-letter-confirm-address} or
5790 @code{mh-alias-minibuffer-confirm-address} if the option
5791 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag} is turned on). @xref{Composing}. This
5792 behavior can be controlled with the option
5793 @code{mh-alias-flash-on-comma} which provides three choices:
5794 @samp{Flash but Don't Warn If No Alias}, @samp{Flash and Warn If No
5795 Alias}, and @samp{Don't Flash Nor Warn If No Alias}.
5796
5797 For another way to verify the alias expansion, see @ref{Checking
5798 Recipients}.
5799
5800 @subheading Loading Aliases
5801
5802 @cindex @command{ali}
5803 @cindex @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}
5804 @cindex @samp{Aliasfile:} MH profile component
5805 @cindex MH commands, @command{ali}
5806 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Aliasfile:}
5807 @cindex files, @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}
5808
5809 MH-E loads aliases for completion and folder name hints from various
5810 places. It uses the MH command @command{ali}@footnote{See the section
5811 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mh.html, MH Aliases} in the MH book.} to
5812 read aliases from the files listed in the profile component
5813 @samp{Aliasfile:} as well as system-wide aliases (for example,
5814 @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}).
5815
5816 @cindex @file{/etc/passwd}
5817 @cindex files, @file{/etc/passwd}
5818
5819 In addition, aliases are created from @file{/etc/passwd} entries with
5820 a user ID larger than a magical number, typically 200. This can be a
5821 handy tool on a machine where you and co-workers exchange messages.
5822 These aliases have the form @samp{local.@var{first.last}} if a real
5823 name is present in the password file. Otherwise, the alias will have
5824 the form @samp{local.@var{login}}.
5825
5826 @vindex mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5827
5828 The prefix @samp{local.} can be modified via the option
5829 @code{mh-alias-local-users-prefix}. This option can also be set to
5830 @samp{Use Login}.
5831
5832 For example, consider the following password file entry:
5833
5834 @smallexample
5835 psg:x:1000:1000:Peter S Galbraith,,,:/home/psg:/bin/tcsh
5836 @end smallexample
5837
5838 @vindex mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5839
5840 The following settings of option @code{mh-alias-local-users-prefix}
5841 will produce the associated aliases:
5842
5843 @table @code
5844 @item "local."
5845 local.peter.galbraith
5846 @c -------------------------
5847 @item ""
5848 peter.galbraith
5849 @c -------------------------
5850 @item Use Login
5851 psg
5852 @end table
5853
5854 @vindex mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag
5855
5856 In the example above, commas are used to separate different values
5857 within the so-called GECOS field. This is a fairly common usage.
5858 However, in the rare case that the GECOS field in your password file
5859 is not separated by commas and whose contents may contain commas, you
5860 can turn the option @code{mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag}
5861 off.
5862
5863 @cindex NIS, obtaining local aliases from
5864 @cindex @samp{ypcat passwd}
5865 @vindex mh-alias-local-users
5866
5867 If you're on a system with thousands of users you don't know, and the
5868 loading of local aliases slows MH-E down noticeably, then the local
5869 alias feature can be disabled by turning off the option
5870 @code{mh-alias-local-users}. This option also takes a string which is
5871 executed to generate the password file. For example, use @samp{ypcat
5872 passwd} to obtain the NIS password file.
5873
5874 @findex mh-alias-reload
5875 @kindex M-x mh-alias-reload
5876 @vindex mh-alias-reloaded-hook
5877
5878 Since aliases are updated frequently, MH-E reloads aliases
5879 automatically whenever an alias lookup occurs if an alias source has
5880 changed. However, you can reload your aliases manually by calling the
5881 command @kbd{M-x mh-alias-reload} directly. This command runs
5882 @code{mh-alias-reloaded-hook} after the aliases have been loaded.
5883
5884 @subheading Adding Aliases
5885
5886 In the past, you have manually added aliases to your alias file(s)
5887 listed in your @samp{Aliasfile:} profile component. MH-E provides
5888 other methods for maintaining your alias file(s).
5889
5890 @findex mh-alias-add-alias
5891 @kindex M-x mh-alias-add-alias
5892
5893 You can use the @kbd{M-x mh-alias-add-alias} command which will prompt
5894 you for the alias and address that you would like to add. If the alias
5895 exists already, you will have the choice of inserting the new alias
5896 before or after the old alias. In the former case, this alias will be
5897 used when sending mail to this alias. In the latter case, the alias
5898 serves as an additional folder name hint when filing messages
5899 (@pxref{Folder Selection}).
5900
5901 Earlier, the alias prefix @samp{local} was presented. You can use
5902 other prefixes to organize your aliases or disambiguate entries. You
5903 might use prefixes for locales, jobs, or activities. For example, I
5904 have:
5905
5906 @smallexample
5907 @group
5908 ; Work
5909 attensity.don.mitchell: Don Mitchell <dmitchell@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5910 isharp.don.mitchell: Don Mitchell <donaldsmitchell@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5911 ...
5912 ; Sport
5913 diving.ken.mayer: Ken Mayer <kmayer@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5914 sailing.mike.maloney: Mike Maloney <mmaloney@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5915 ...
5916 ; Personal
5917 ariane.kolkmann: Ariane Kolkmann <ArianeKolkmann@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5918 ...
5919 @end group
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 Using prefixes instead of postfixes helps you explore aliases during
5923 completion. If you forget the name of an old dive buddy, you can enter
5924 @samp{div} and then @key{SPC} to get a listing of all your dive buddies.
5925
5926 @kindex M-x mh-alias-add-address-under-point
5927 @kindex M-x mh-alias-grab-from-field
5928
5929 An alias for the sender of the current message is added automatically
5930 by clicking on the @samp{Grab From alias} tool bar button or by running
5931 the @kbd{M-x mh-alias-grab-from-field} command. Aliases for other
5932 recipients of the current message are added by placing your cursor
5933 over the desired recipient and giving the @kbd{M-x
5934 mh-alias-add-address-under-point} command.
5935
5936 @vindex mh-alias-insert-file
5937 @vindex mh-alias-insertion-location
5938
5939 The options @code{mh-alias-insert-file} and
5940 @code{mh-alias-insertion-location} controls how and where these aliases
5941 are inserted.
5942
5943 @vindex mh-alias-insert-file
5944
5945 The default setting of option @code{mh-alias-insert-file} is @samp{Use
5946 Aliasfile Profile Component}. This option can also hold the name of a
5947 file or a list a file names. If this option is set to a list of file
5948 names, or the @samp{Aliasfile:} profile component contains more than
5949 one file name, MH-E will prompt for one of them.
5950
5951 @vindex mh-alias-insertion-location
5952
5953 The option @code{mh-alias-insertion-location} is set to
5954 @samp{Alphabetical} by default. If you organize your alias file in
5955 other ways, then the settings @samp{Top} and @samp{Bottom} might be
5956 more appropriate.
5957
5958 @subheading Querying Aliases
5959
5960 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-alias-apropos}
5961 @findex mh-alias-apropos
5962 @kindex M-x mh-alias-apropos
5963
5964 If you can't quite remember an alias, you can use @kbd{M-x
5965 mh-alias-apropos} to show all aliases or addresses that match a
5966 regular expression
5967 @ifnothtml
5968 (@pxref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
5969 GNU Emacs Manual}).
5970 @end ifnothtml
5971 @ifhtml
5972 (see the section
5973 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
5974 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in
5975 @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5976 @end ifhtml
5977
5978 @node Identities, Speedbar, Aliases, Top
5979 @chapter Identities
5980
5981 @cindex identities
5982 @cindex multiple personalities
5983
5984 MH-E supports the concept of multiple personalities or identities.
5985 This means that you can easily have a different header and signature
5986 at home and at work.
5987
5988 @cindex @samp{Identity} menu
5989 @cindex menu, @samp{Identity}
5990
5991 A couple of commands are used to insert identities in MH-Letter mode
5992 which are also found in the @samp{Identity} menu.
5993
5994 @table @kbd
5995 @kindex C-c C-d
5996 @findex mh-insert-identity
5997 @item C-c C-d
5998 Insert fields specified by given identity (@code{mh-insert-identity}).
5999 @c -------------------------
6000 @cindex @samp{Identity > Insert Auto Fields} menu item
6001 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Insert Auto Fields}
6002 @kindex C-c M-d
6003 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
6004 @item C-c M-d
6005 Insert custom fields if recipient found in @code{mh-auto-fields-list}
6006 (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}).
6007 @end table
6008
6009 @cindex @samp{mh-identity} customization group
6010 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-identity}
6011
6012 The @samp{mh-identity} customization group contains the following
6013 options.
6014
6015 @vtable @code
6016 @item mh-auto-fields-list
6017 List of recipients for which header lines are automatically inserted
6018 (default: @code{nil}).
6019 @c -------------------------
6020 @item mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag
6021 On means to prompt before sending if fields inserted (default:
6022 @samp{on})
6023 @c -------------------------
6024 @item mh-identity-default
6025 Default identity to use when @code{mh-letter-mode} is called (default:
6026 @samp{None}).
6027 @c -------------------------
6028 @item mh-identity-handlers
6029 Handler functions for fields in @code{mh-identity-list}.
6030 @c -------------------------
6031 @item mh-identity-list
6032 List of identities (default: @code{nil}).
6033 @end vtable
6034
6035 Some of the common header fields that people change depending on the
6036 context are the @samp{From:} and @samp{Organization:} fields, as well
6037 as the signature.
6038
6039 @vindex mh-identity-list
6040
6041 This is done by customizing the option @code{mh-identity-list}. In the
6042 customization buffer for this option, click on the @samp{INS} button
6043 and enter a label such as @samp{Home} or @samp{Work}. Then click on
6044 the @samp{INS} button with the label @samp{Add at least one item
6045 below}. The @samp{Value Menu} has the following menu items:
6046
6047 @table @samp
6048 @cindex header field, @samp{From:}
6049 @cindex @samp{From:} header field
6050 @item From Field
6051 Specify an alternate @samp{From:} header field. You must include a
6052 valid email address. A standard format is @samp{First Last
6053 <login@@host.domain>}. If you use an initial with a period, then you
6054 must quote your name as in @samp{"First I. Last"
6055 <login@@host.domain>}.
6056 @c -------------------------
6057 @cindex header field, @samp{Organization:}
6058 @cindex @samp{Organization:} header field
6059 @item Organization Field
6060 People usually list the name of the company where they work here.
6061 @c -------------------------
6062 @item Other Field
6063 Set any arbitrary header field and value here. Unless the header field
6064 is a standard one, precede the name of your field's label with
6065 @samp{X-}, as in @samp{X-Fruit-of-the-Day:}.
6066 @c -------------------------
6067 @item Attribution Verb
6068 This value overrides the setting of
6069 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. @xref{Inserting Letter}.
6070 @c -------------------------
6071 @cindex signature
6072 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
6073 @item Signature
6074 Set your signature with this item. You can specify the contents of
6075 @code{mh-signature-file-name}, a file, or a function.
6076 @xref{Signature}.
6077 @c -------------------------
6078 @item GPG Key ID
6079 Specify a different key to sign or encrypt messages.
6080 @end table
6081
6082 @cindex Identity menu
6083 @cindex menu, Identity
6084 @findex mh-insert-identity
6085 @kindex C-c C-d
6086
6087 You can select the identities you have added via the menu called
6088 @samp{Identity} in the MH-Letter buffer. You can also use @kbd{C-c
6089 C-d} (@code{mh-insert-identity}). To clear the fields and signature
6090 added by the identity, select the @samp{None} identity.
6091
6092 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Customize Identities}
6093 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Save as Default}
6094 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Set Default for Session}
6095 @cindex @samp{Identity > Customize Identities} menu item
6096 @cindex @samp{Identity > Save as Default} menu item
6097 @cindex @samp{Identity > Set Default for Session} menu item
6098 @vindex mh-identity-default
6099
6100 The @samp{Identity} menu contains two other items to save you from
6101 having to set the identity on every message. The menu item @samp{Set
6102 Default for Session} can be used to set the default identity to the
6103 current identity until you exit Emacs. The menu item @samp{Save as
6104 Default} sets the option @code{mh-identity-default} to the current
6105 identity setting. You can also customize the option
6106 @code{mh-identity-default} in the usual fashion. If you find that you
6107 need to add another identity, the menu item @samp{Customize
6108 Identities} is available for your convenience.
6109
6110 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-auto-fields-list}
6111 @vindex mh-auto-fields-list
6112
6113 The option @code{mh-auto-fields-list} can also be used to set the
6114 identity depending on the recipient to provide even more control. To
6115 customize @code{mh-auto-fields-list}, click on the @samp{INS} button
6116 and enter a regular expression for the recipient's address
6117 @ifnothtml
6118 (@pxref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
6119 GNU Emacs Manual}).
6120 @end ifnothtml
6121 @ifhtml
6122 (see the section
6123 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
6124 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in
6125 @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6126 @end ifhtml
6127 Click on the @samp{INS} button with the @samp{Add at least one item
6128 below} label. The @samp{Value Menu} contains the following menu items:
6129
6130 @table @samp
6131 @item Identity
6132 Select an identity from those configured in @code{mh-identity-list}.
6133 All of the information for that identity will be added if the
6134 recipient matches.
6135 @c -------------------------
6136 @cindex @samp{Fcc:} header field
6137 @cindex header field, @samp{Fcc:}
6138 @item Fcc Field
6139 Insert an @samp{Fcc:} header field with the folder you provide. When
6140 you send the message, MH will put a copy of your message in this
6141 folder.
6142 @c -------------------------
6143 @cindex @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field
6144 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Followup-To:}
6145 @item Mail-Followup-To Field
6146 Insert an @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field with the recipients
6147 you provide. If the recipient's mail user agent supports this header
6148 field@footnote{@samp{Mail-Followup-To:} is supported by nmh.}, then
6149 their replies will go to the addresses listed. This is useful if their
6150 replies go both to the list and to you and you don't have a mechanism
6151 to suppress duplicates. If you reply to someone not on the list, you
6152 must either remove the @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} field, or ensure the
6153 recipient is also listed there so that he receives replies to your
6154 reply.
6155 @c -------------------------
6156 @item Other Field
6157 Other header fields may be added using this menu item.
6158 @end table
6159
6160 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
6161 @kindex C-c M-d
6162 @vindex mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag
6163
6164 These fields can only be added after the recipient is known. Because
6165 you can continue to add recipients as you edit the draft, MH-E waits
6166 until the message is sent to perform the auto-insertions. This seems
6167 strange at first, but you'll get used to it. There are two ways to
6168 help you feel that the desired fields are added. The first is the
6169 action when the message is sent: if any fields are added
6170 automatically, you are given a chance to see and to confirm these
6171 fields before the message is actually sent. You can do away with this
6172 confirmation by turning off the option
6173 @code{mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag}. The second method is manual: once
6174 the header contains one or more recipients, you may run the command
6175 @kbd{C-c M-d} (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}) or choose the
6176 @samp{Identity -> Insert Auto Fields} menu item to insert these fields
6177 manually. However, if you use this command, the automatic insertion
6178 when the message is sent is disabled.
6179
6180 @vindex mh-auto-fields-list
6181 @vindex mh-identity-list
6182
6183 You should avoid using the same header field in
6184 @code{mh-auto-fields-list} and @code{mh-identity-list} definitions
6185 that may apply to the same message as the result is undefined.
6186
6187 @vindex mh-identity-handlers
6188 @vindex mh-identity-list
6189
6190 The option @code{mh-identity-handlers} is used to change the way that
6191 fields, signatures, and attributions in @code{mh-identity-list} are
6192 added. To customize @code{mh-identity-handlers}, replace the name of
6193 an existing handler function associated with the field you want to
6194 change with the name of a function you have written. You can also
6195 click on an @samp{INS} button and insert a field of your choice and
6196 the name of the function you have written to handle it.
6197
6198 @vindex mh-identity-list
6199
6200 The @samp{Field} field can be any field that you've used in your
6201 @code{mh-identity-list}. The special fields @samp{:attribution-verb},
6202 @samp{:signature}, or @samp{:pgg-default-user-id} are used for the
6203 @code{mh-identity-list} choices @samp{Attribution Verb},
6204 @samp{Signature}, and @samp{GPG Key ID} respectively.
6205
6206 The handler associated with the @samp{:default} field is used when no
6207 other field matches.
6208
6209 The handler functions are passed two or three arguments: the field
6210 itself (for example, @samp{From}), or one of the special fields (for
6211 example, @samp{:signature}), and the action @samp{'remove} or
6212 @samp{'add}. If the action is @samp{'add}, an additional argument
6213 containing the value for the field is given.
6214
6215 @node Speedbar, Menu Bar, Identities, Top
6216 @chapter The Speedbar
6217
6218 @cindex folder navigation
6219 @cindex speedbar
6220 @findex mh-visit-folder
6221 @kindex F v
6222 @kindex M-x speedbar
6223 @kindex Mouse-2
6224
6225 You can also use the speedbar
6226 @ifnothtml
6227 (@pxref{Speedbar, , Speedbar Frames, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},)
6228 @end ifnothtml
6229 @ifhtml
6230 (see the section
6231 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Speedbar.html,
6232 Speedbar Frames} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual})
6233 @end ifhtml
6234 to view your folders. To bring up the speedbar, run @kbd{M-x speedbar
6235 @key{RET}}. You will see a new frame appear with all of your MH
6236 folders. Folders with unseen messages appear in boldface. Click on a
6237 folder name with @kbd{Mouse-2} to visit that folder in a similar
6238 fashion to the command @kbd{F v} (@code{mh-visit-folder})
6239 (@pxref{Folders}). Click on the @samp{+} icon to expand and view the
6240 sub-folders of that folder.
6241
6242 The speedbar can be manipulated with the keyboard as well. Use the
6243 Emacs navigational keys (like the arrow keys, or @kbd{C-n}) to move
6244 the cursor over the desired folder and then use the shortcuts for the
6245 menu items listed in the table below.
6246
6247 @table @samp
6248 @findex mh-speed-view
6249 @item Visit Folder (@key{RET})
6250 Visits the selected folder just as if you had used @kbd{F v}
6251 (@code{mh-speed-view}).
6252 @c -------------------------
6253 @findex mh-speed-expand-folder
6254 @item Expand Nested Folders (@kbd{+})
6255 Expands the selected folder in the speedbar, exposing the children
6256 folders inside it (@code{mh-speed-expand-folder}).
6257 @c -------------------------
6258 @findex mh-speed-contract-folder
6259 @item Contract Nested Folders (@kbd{-})
6260 Contracts or collapses the selected folder in the speedbar, hiding the
6261 children folders inside it (@code{mh-speed-contract-folder}).
6262 @c -------------------------
6263 @findex mh-speed-refresh
6264 @item Refresh Speedbar (@kbd{r})
6265 Regenerates the list of folders in the speedbar. Run this command if
6266 you've added or deleted a folder, or want to update the unseen message
6267 count before the next automatic update (@code{mh-speed-refresh}).
6268 @end table
6269
6270 @findex delete-frame
6271 @kindex C-x 5 0
6272 @kindex Mouse-3
6273
6274 You can click on @kbd{Mouse-3} to bring up a context menu that
6275 contains these items. Dismiss the speedbar with @kbd{C-x 5 0}
6276 (@code{delete-frame}).
6277
6278 @cindex @command{flists}
6279 @cindex MH commands, @command{flists}
6280 @cindex @samp{mh-speedbar} customization group
6281 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-speedbar}
6282
6283 The MH-E speedbar uses the MH command @command{flists}@footnote{See
6284 the section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/morseq.html#flist, Searching for
6285 Sequences with flist} in the MH book.} to generate the list of
6286 folders. The @samp{mh-speedbar} customization group contains the
6287 following option which controls how often the speedbar calls
6288 @command{flists}.
6289
6290 @vtable @code
6291 @item mh-speed-update-interval
6292 Time between speedbar updates in seconds (default: 60). Set to 0 to
6293 disable automatic update.
6294 @end vtable
6295
6296 You can modify the appearance of the folders in the speedbar by
6297 customizing the following faces.
6298
6299 @vtable @code
6300 @item mh-speedbar-folder
6301 Basic folder face.
6302 @c -------------------------
6303 @item mh-speedbar-folder-with-unseen-messages
6304 Folder face when folder contains unread messages.
6305 @c -------------------------
6306 @item mh-speedbar-selected-folder
6307 Selected folder face.
6308 @c -------------------------
6309 @item mh-speedbar-selected-folder-with-unseen-messages
6310 Selected folder face when folder contains unread messages.
6311 @end vtable
6312
6313 @node Menu Bar, Tool Bar, Speedbar, Top
6314 @chapter The Menu Bar
6315
6316 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
6317 @cindex @samp{Identity} menu
6318 @cindex @samp{Letter} menu
6319 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
6320 @cindex @samp{Search} menu
6321 @cindex @samp{Sequence} menu
6322 @cindex Folder menu
6323 @cindex Identity menu
6324 @cindex Letter menu
6325 @cindex MH-Folder mode
6326 @cindex MH-Letter mode
6327 @cindex MH-Search mode
6328 @cindex Message menu
6329 @cindex Search menu
6330 @cindex Sequence menu
6331 @cindex menu bar
6332 @cindex menu, Folder
6333 @cindex menu, Identity
6334 @cindex menu, Letter
6335 @cindex menu, Message
6336 @cindex menu, Search
6337 @cindex menu, Sequence
6338 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
6339 @cindex menu, @samp{Identity}
6340 @cindex menu, @samp{Letter}
6341 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
6342 @cindex menu, @samp{Search}
6343 @cindex menu, @samp{Sequence}
6344 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
6345 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
6346 @cindex modes, MH-Search
6347
6348 For those of you who prefer to mouse and menu instead of using the
6349 meta-coke-bottle-bucky keys, MH-E provides menu items for most of its
6350 functions. The MH-Folder buffer adds the @samp{Folder},
6351 @samp{Message}, and @samp{Sequence} menus. The MH-Letter buffer adds
6352 the @samp{Identity} and @samp{Letter} menus. The MH-Search buffer adds
6353 the @samp{Search} menu. There's no need to list the actual items here,
6354 as you can more easily see them for yourself, and the functions are
6355 already described elsewhere in this manual.
6356
6357 For a description of the menu bar, please
6358 @ifnothtml
6359 @xref{Menu Bar, , The Menu Bar, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6360 @end ifnothtml
6361 @ifhtml
6362 see the section
6363 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Menu-Bar.html,
6364 The Menu Bar} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6365 @end ifhtml
6366
6367 The Emacs manual describes how to get online help for a particular
6368 menu item. You can also look up a menu item in the index of this
6369 manual in two ways: all of the menu items are listed alphabetically,
6370 and you can also browse all of the items under the index entry
6371 @samp{menu item}.
6372
6373 @node Tool Bar, Searching, Menu Bar, Top
6374 @chapter The Tool Bar
6375
6376 @cindex tool bar
6377
6378 Emacs also provides a graphical tool bar. For a description of the
6379 tool bar, please
6380 @ifnothtml
6381 @xref{Tool Bars, , Tool Bars, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6382 @end ifnothtml
6383 @ifhtml
6384 see the section
6385 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Tool-Bars.html,
6386 Tool Bars} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6387 @end ifhtml
6388
6389 @cindex @samp{mh-tool-bar} customization group
6390 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-tool-bar}
6391
6392 MH-E adds several icons to this tool bar; you can modify the MH-E
6393 aspects of the tool bar via the @samp{mh-tool-bar} customization group.
6394
6395 @vtable @code
6396 @item mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons
6397 List of buttons to include in MH-Folder tool bar (default: a checklist
6398 too long to list here).
6399 @c -------------------------
6400 @item mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons
6401 List of buttons to include in MH-Letter tool bar (default: a checklist
6402 too long to list here).
6403 @c -------------------------
6404 @item mh-tool-bar-search-function
6405 Function called by the tool bar search button (default:
6406 @code{mh-search}).
6407 @c -------------------------
6408 @item mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position
6409 Tool bar location (default: @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar}).
6410 @c -------------------------
6411 @item mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag
6412 If @samp{on}, use tool bar (default: @samp{on}, if supported).
6413 @end vtable
6414
6415 In GNU Emacs, icons for some of MH-E's functions are added to the tool
6416 bar. In XEmacs, you have the opportunity to create a separate tool bar for
6417 the MH-E icons.
6418
6419 @vindex mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons
6420 @vindex mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons
6421
6422 In either case, you can select which of these functions you'd like to
6423 see by customizing the options @code{mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons} and
6424 @code{mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons}. As you probably guessed, the former
6425 customizes the tool bar in MH-Folder mode and the latter in MH-Letter
6426 mode. Both of these options present you with a list of functions;
6427 check the functions whose icons you want to see and clear the check
6428 boxes for those you don't.
6429
6430 @findex mh-search
6431 @vindex mh-tool-bar-search-function
6432
6433 The function associated with the searching icon can be set via the
6434 option @code{mh-tool-bar-search-function}. By default, this is set to
6435 @code{mh-search}. @xref{Searching}. You can also choose @samp{Other
6436 Function} from the @samp{Value Menu} and enter a function of your own
6437 choosing.
6438
6439 @vindex mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag
6440
6441 XEmacs provides a couple of extra options. The first,
6442 @code{mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag}, controls whether to show the MH-E
6443 icons at all. By default, this option is turned on if the window
6444 system supports tool bars. If your system doesn't support tool bars,
6445 then you won't be able to turn on this option.
6446
6447 @vindex mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position
6448
6449 The second extra option is @code{mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position} which
6450 controls the placement of the tool bar along the four edges of the
6451 frame. You can choose from one of @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar},
6452 @samp{Top}, @samp{Bottom}, @samp{Left}, or @samp{Right}. If this
6453 variable is set to anything other than @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar}
6454 and the default tool bar is in a different location, then two tool
6455 bars will be displayed: the MH-E tool bar and the default tool bar.
6456
6457 @node Searching, Threading, Tool Bar, Top
6458 @chapter Searching Through Messages
6459
6460 @cindex @samp{Search} menu
6461 @cindex menu, @samp{Search}
6462 @cindex searching
6463 @findex mh-search
6464 @kindex F s
6465
6466 Earlier, the command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}) was introduced which
6467 helps you find messages that lie buried in your folders
6468 (@pxref{Folders}). This chapter covers this command in more detail.
6469 Several commands are used to compose the search criteria and to start
6470 searching. A couple of them can be found in the @samp{Search} menu.
6471
6472 @table @kbd
6473 @kindex C-c ?
6474 @findex mh-help
6475 @item C-c ?
6476 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
6477 @c -------------------------
6478 @cindex @samp{Search > Perform Search} menu item
6479 @cindex menu item, @samp{Search > Perform Search}
6480 @kindex C-c C-c
6481 @findex mh-index-do-search
6482 @item C-c C-c
6483 Find messages using @code{mh-search-program}
6484 (@code{mh-index-do-search}).
6485 @c -------------------------
6486 @cindex @samp{Search > Search with pick} menu item
6487 @cindex menu item, @samp{Search > Search with pick}
6488 @kindex C-c C-p
6489 @findex mh-pick-do-search
6490 @item C-c C-p
6491 Find messages using @command{pick} (@code{mh-pick-do-search}).
6492 @c -------------------------
6493 @kindex C-c ?
6494 @findex mh-help
6495 @item C-c ?
6496 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
6497 @c -------------------------
6498 @kindex C-c C-f C-a
6499 @kindex C-c C-f a
6500 @findex mh-to-field
6501 @item C-c C-f a
6502 @itemx C-c C-f C-a
6503 Move to @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6504 @c -------------------------
6505 @kindex C-c C-f C-b
6506 @kindex C-c C-f b
6507 @item C-c C-f b
6508 @itemx C-c C-f C-b
6509 Move to @samp{Bcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6510 @c -------------------------
6511 @kindex C-c C-f C-c
6512 @kindex C-c C-f c
6513 @item C-c C-f c
6514 @itemx C-c C-f C-c
6515 Move to @samp{Cc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6516 @c -------------------------
6517 @kindex C-c C-f C-d
6518 @kindex C-c C-f d
6519 @item C-c C-f d
6520 @itemx C-c C-f C-d
6521 Move to @samp{Dcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6522 @c -------------------------
6523 @kindex C-c C-f C-f
6524 @kindex C-c C-f f
6525 @item C-c C-f f
6526 @itemx C-c C-f C-f
6527 Move to @samp{Fcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6528 @c -------------------------
6529 @kindex C-c C-f C-l
6530 @kindex C-c C-f l
6531 @item C-c C-f l
6532 @itemx C-c C-f C-l
6533 Move to @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6534 @c -------------------------
6535 @kindex C-c C-f C-m
6536 @kindex C-c C-f m
6537 @item C-c C-f m
6538 @itemx C-c C-f C-m
6539 Move to @samp{From:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6540 @c -------------------------
6541 @kindex C-c C-f C-r
6542 @kindex C-c C-f r
6543 @item C-c C-f r
6544 @itemx C-c C-f C-r
6545 Move to @samp{Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6546 @c -------------------------
6547 @kindex C-c C-f C-s
6548 @kindex C-c C-f s
6549 @item C-c C-f s
6550 @itemx C-c C-f C-s
6551 Move to @samp{Subject:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6552 @c -------------------------
6553 @kindex C-c C-f C-t
6554 @kindex C-c C-f t
6555 @item C-c C-f t
6556 @itemx C-c C-f C-t
6557 Move to @samp{To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6558 @end table
6559
6560 Another few commands are available in the MH-Folder buffer resulting
6561 from a search.
6562
6563 @table @kbd
6564 @kindex @key{TAB}
6565 @findex mh-index-next-folder
6566 @item @key{TAB}
6567 Jump to the next folder marker (@code{mh-index-next-folder}).
6568 @c -------------------------
6569 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
6570 @findex mh-index-previous-folder
6571 @item S-@key{TAB}
6572 Jump to the previous folder marker (@code{mh-index-previous-folder}).
6573 @c -------------------------
6574 @kindex v
6575 @findex mh-index-visit-folder
6576 @item v
6577 Visit original folder from where the message at point was found
6578 (@code{mh-index-visit-folder}).
6579 @end table
6580
6581 @cindex @samp{mh-search} customization group
6582 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-search}
6583
6584 There is one option from the @samp{mh-search} customization group used
6585 in searching.
6586
6587 @vtable @code
6588 @item mh-search-program
6589 Search program that MH-E shall use (default: @samp{Auto-detect}).
6590 @end vtable
6591
6592 The following hook is available.
6593
6594 @vtable @code
6595 @item mh-search-mode-hook
6596 Hook run upon entry to @code{mh-search-mode} (default: @code{nil}).
6597 @end vtable
6598
6599 The following face is available.
6600
6601 @vtable @code
6602 @item mh-search-folder
6603 Folder heading face in MH-Folder buffers created by searches.
6604 @end vtable
6605
6606 @findex mh-search-folder
6607 @kindex F s
6608
6609 The command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search-folder}) helps you find
6610 messages in your entire corpus of mail. You can search for messages to
6611 or from a particular person or about a particular subject. In fact,
6612 you can also search for messages containing selected strings in any
6613 arbitrary header field or any string found within the messages.
6614
6615 @cindex @command{pick}
6616 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6617
6618 Out of the box, MH-E uses @command{pick} to find messages. With a
6619 little extra effort, you can set an indexing program which rewards you
6620 with extremely quick results. The drawback is that sometimes the index
6621 does not contain the words you're looking for. You can still use
6622 @command{pick} in these situations.
6623
6624 You are prompted for the folder to search. This can be @samp{all} to
6625 search all folders. Note that the search works recursively on the
6626 listed folder.
6627
6628 @cindex MH-Search mode
6629 @cindex modes, MH-Search
6630
6631 Next, an MH-Search buffer appears where you can enter search criteria.
6632
6633 @cartouche
6634 @smallexample
6635 From:
6636 To:
6637 Cc:
6638 Date:
6639 Subject:
6640 --------
6641 #
6642
6643
6644
6645
6646
6647
6648
6649
6650 --:** search-pattern All L7 (MH-Search)---------------------------
6651 Type C-c C-c to search messages, C-c C-p to use pick, C-c ? for help
6652 @end smallexample
6653 @end cartouche
6654 @i{Search window}
6655
6656 @cindex @command{pick}
6657 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6658
6659 Edit this template by entering your search criteria in an appropriate
6660 header field that is already there, or create a new field yourself. If
6661 the string you're looking for could be anywhere in a message, then
6662 place the string underneath the row of dashes.
6663
6664 As an example, let's say that we want to find messages from Ginnean
6665 about horseback riding in the Kosciusko National Park (Australia)
6666 during January, 1994. Normally we would start with a broad search and
6667 narrow it down if necessary to produce a manageable amount of data,
6668 but we'll cut to the chase and create a fairly restrictive set of
6669 criteria as follows:
6670
6671 @smallexample
6672 @group
6673 From: ginnean
6674 To:
6675 Cc:
6676 Date: Jan 1994
6677 Subject:
6678 --------
6679 horse
6680 kosciusko
6681 @end group
6682 @end smallexample
6683
6684 @findex mh-to-field
6685 @kindex C-c C-f C-t
6686
6687 As with MH-Letter mode, MH-Search provides commands like @kbd{C-c C-f
6688 C-t} (@code{mh-to-field}) to help you fill in the blanks.
6689 @xref{Editing Message}.
6690
6691 @kindex F s
6692 @vindex mh-search-mode-hook
6693
6694 If you find that you do the same thing over and over when editing the
6695 search template, you may wish to bind some shortcuts to keys. This can
6696 be done with the variable @code{mh-search-mode-hook}, which is called
6697 when @kbd{F s} is run on a new pattern.
6698
6699 @findex mh-index-do-search
6700 @findex mh-pick-do-search
6701 @kindex C-c C-c
6702 @kindex C-c C-p
6703
6704 To perform the search, type @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{mh-index-do-search}).
6705 Sometimes you're searching for text that is either not indexed, or
6706 hasn't been indexed yet. In this case you can override the default
6707 method with the pick method by running the command @kbd{C-c C-p}
6708 (@code{mh-pick-do-search}).
6709
6710 @cindex folders, @samp{+mhe-index}
6711 @cindex @samp{+mhe-index}
6712 @findex mh-index-next-folder
6713 @findex mh-index-previous-folder
6714 @kindex @key{TAB}
6715 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
6716 @vindex mh-search-folder
6717
6718 The messages that are found are put in a temporary sub-folder of
6719 @samp{+mhe-index} and are displayed in an MH-Folder buffer. This
6720 buffer is special because it displays messages from multiple folders;
6721 each set of messages from a given folder has a heading with the folder
6722 name. The appearance of the heading can be modified by customizing the
6723 face @code{mh-search-folder}. You can jump back and forth between the
6724 headings using the commands @kbd{@key{TAB}}
6725 (@code{mh-index-next-folder}) and @kbd{S-@key{TAB}}
6726 (@code{mh-index-previous-folder}).
6727
6728 @findex mh-index-visit-folder
6729 @findex mh-rescan-folder
6730 @kindex F r
6731 @kindex v
6732
6733 In addition, the command @kbd{v} (@code{mh-index-visit-folder}) can be
6734 used to visit the folder of the message at point. Initially, only the
6735 messages that matched the search criteria are displayed in the folder.
6736 While the temporary buffer has its own set of message numbers, the
6737 actual messages numbers are shown in the visited folder. Thus, the
6738 command @kbd{v} is useful to find the actual message number of an
6739 interesting message, or to view surrounding messages with the command
6740 @kbd{F r} @code{mh-rescan-folder}. @xref{Folders}.
6741
6742 @findex mh-kill-folder
6743 @kindex F k
6744
6745 Because this folder is temporary, you'll probably get in the habit of
6746 killing it when you're done with @kbd{F k} (@code{mh-kill-folder}).
6747 @xref{Folders}.
6748
6749 @kindex F s
6750
6751 You can regenerate the results by running @kbd{F s} with a prefix
6752 argument.
6753
6754 @cindex @command{procmail}
6755 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
6756 @cindex @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} header field
6757 @cindex header field, @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:}
6758
6759 Note: This command uses an @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} header field to
6760 cache the MD5 checksum of a message. This means that if an incoming
6761 message already contains an @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} field, that message
6762 might not be found by this command. The following @command{procmail}
6763 recipe avoids this problem by renaming the existing header field:
6764
6765 @smallexample
6766 @group
6767 :0 wf
6768 | formail -R "X-MHE-Checksum" "X-Old-MHE-Checksum"
6769 @end group
6770 @end smallexample
6771
6772 @xref{Limits}, for an alternative interface to searching.
6773
6774 @section Configuring Indexed Searches
6775
6776 @cindex @command{grep}
6777 @cindex @command{mairix}
6778 @cindex @command{namazu}
6779 @cindex @command{pick}
6780 @cindex @command{swish++}
6781 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6782 @cindex Unix commands, @command{grep}
6783 @cindex Unix commands, @command{mairix}
6784 @cindex Unix commands, @command{namazu}
6785 @cindex Unix commands, @command{pick}
6786 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish++}
6787 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6788 @findex mh-search
6789 @kindex F s
6790 @vindex mh-search-program
6791
6792 The command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}) runs the command defined by
6793 the option @code{mh-search-program}. The default value is
6794 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose one
6795 of @command{swish++}, @command{swish-e}, @command{mairix},
6796 @command{namazu}, @command{pick} and @command{grep} in that order. If,
6797 for example, you have both @command{swish++} and @command{mairix}
6798 installed and you want to use @command{mairix}, then you can set this
6799 option to @samp{mairix}.
6800
6801 The following sub-sections describe how to set up the various indexing
6802 programs to use with MH-E.
6803
6804 @subsection swish++
6805
6806 @cindex @command{swish++}
6807 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish++}
6808
6809 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6810 your MH directory.
6811
6812 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish++}. Then
6813 create the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.conf} with the
6814 following contents:
6815
6816 @smallexample
6817 @group
6818 IncludeMeta Bcc Cc Comments Content-Description From Keywords
6819 IncludeMeta Newsgroups Resent-To Subject To
6820 IncludeMeta Message-Id References In-Reply-To
6821 IncludeFile Mail *
6822 IndexFile /home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.index
6823 @end group
6824 @end smallexample
6825
6826 Use the following command line to generate the swish index. Run this
6827 daily from cron:
6828
6829 @smallexample
6830 @group
6831 find /home/user/Mail -path /home/user/Mail/mhe-index -prune \
6832 -o -path /home/user/Mail/.swish++ -prune \
6833 -o -name "[0-9]*" -print \
6834 | index -c /home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.conf -
6835 @end group
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 This command does not index the folders that hold the results of your
6839 searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and the
6840 original messages are indexed anyway.
6841
6842 @cindex @command{index}
6843 @cindex Unix commands, @command{index}
6844 @cindex @command{index++}
6845 @cindex Unix commands, @command{index++}
6846
6847 On some systems (Debian GNU/Linux, for example), use @command{index++}
6848 instead of @command{index}.
6849
6850 @subsection swish
6851
6852 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6853 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6854
6855 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6856 your MH directory.
6857
6858 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish}. Then create
6859 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish/config} with the following
6860 contents:
6861
6862 @smallexample
6863 @group
6864 DefaultContents TXT*
6865 IndexDir /home/user/Mail
6866 IndexFile /home/user/Mail/.swish/index
6867 IndexName "Mail Index"
6868 IndexDescription "Mail Index"
6869 IndexPointer "http://nowhere"
6870 IndexAdmin "nobody"
6871 #MetaNames automatic
6872 IndexReport 3
6873 FollowSymLinks no
6874 UseStemming no
6875 IgnoreTotalWordCountWhenRanking yes
6876 WordCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789-
6877 BeginCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
6878 EndCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789
6879 IgnoreLimit 50 1000
6880 IndexComments 0
6881 FileRules filename contains \D
6882 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/.swish
6883 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/mhe-index
6884 FileRules filename is index
6885 @end group
6886 @end smallexample
6887
6888 This configuration does not index the folders that hold the results of
6889 your searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and
6890 the original messages are indexed anyway.
6891
6892 If there are any directories you would like to ignore, append lines
6893 like the following to @file{config}:
6894
6895 @smallexample
6896 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/scripts
6897 @end smallexample
6898
6899 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6900 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6901
6902 Use the following command line to generate the swish index. Run this
6903 daily from cron:
6904
6905 @smallexample
6906 swish-e -c /home/user/Mail/.swish/config
6907 @end smallexample
6908
6909 @subsection mairix
6910
6911 @cindex @command{mairix}
6912 @cindex Unix commands, @command{mairix}
6913
6914 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6915 your MH directory.
6916
6917 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.mairix}. Then create
6918 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.mairix/config} with the following
6919 contents:
6920
6921 @smallexample
6922 @group
6923 base=/home/user/Mail
6924
6925 # List of folders that should be indexed. 3 dots at the end means there
6926 # are subfolders within the folder
6927 mh=archive...:inbox:drafts:news:sent:trash
6928
6929 vfolder_format=raw
6930 database=/home/user/Mail/mairix/database
6931 @end group
6932 @end smallexample
6933
6934 Use the following command line to generate the mairix index. Run this daily
6935 from cron:
6936
6937 @smallexample
6938 mairix -f /home/user/Mail/.mairix/config
6939 @end smallexample
6940
6941 @subsection namazu
6942
6943 @cindex @command{namazu}
6944 @cindex Unix commands, @command{namazu}
6945
6946 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6947 your MH directory.
6948
6949 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.namazu}. Then create
6950 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.namazu/mknmzrc} with the following
6951 contents:
6952
6953 @smallexample
6954 @group
6955 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
6956 $ADDRESS = 'user@@localhost';
6957 $ALLOW_FILE = "[0-9]*";
6958 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "^/home/user/Mail/(mhe-index|spam)";
6959 @end group
6960 @end smallexample
6961
6962 This configuration does not index the folders that hold the results of
6963 your searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and
6964 the original messages are indexed anyway.
6965
6966 Use the following command line to generate the namazu index. Run this
6967 daily from cron:
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 mknmz -f /home/user/Mail/.namazu/mknmzrc -O /home/user/Mail/.namazu \
6971 /home/user/Mail
6972 @end smallexample
6973
6974 @subsection pick
6975
6976 @cindex @command{pick}
6977 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6978
6979 This search method does not require any setup.
6980
6981 Read @command{pick}(1) or the section
6982 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/finpic.html, Finding Messages with pick} in
6983 the MH book to find out more about how to enter the criteria.
6984
6985 @subsection grep
6986
6987 @cindex @command{grep}
6988 @cindex Unix commands, @command{grep}
6989
6990 This search method does not require any setup.
6991
6992 Unlike the other search methods, this method does not use the
6993 MH-Search buffer. Instead, you simply enter a regular expression in
6994 the minibuffer. For help in constructing regular expressions, see your
6995 man page for @command{grep}.
6996
6997 @node Threading, Limits, Searching, Top
6998 @chapter Viewing Message Threads
6999
7000 @cindex threading
7001
7002 MH-E groups messages by @dfn{threads} which are messages that are part
7003 of the same discussion and usually all have the same @samp{Subject:}
7004 header field. Other ways to organize messages in a folder include
7005 limiting (@pxref{Limits}) or using full-text indexed searches
7006 (@pxref{Searching}).
7007
7008 @cindex root, in threads
7009 @cindex siblings, in threads
7010 @cindex ancestor, in threads
7011
7012 A thread begins with a single message called a @dfn{root}. All replies
7013 to the same message are @dfn{siblings} of each other. Any message that
7014 has replies to it is an @dfn{ancestor} of those replies.
7015
7016 There are several commands that you can use to navigate and operate on
7017 threads.
7018
7019 @table @kbd
7020 @kindex T ?
7021 @findex mh-prefix-help
7022 @item T ?
7023 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7024 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7025 @c -------------------------
7026 @kindex T o
7027 @findex mh-thread-refile
7028 @item T o
7029 Refile (output) thread into folder (@code{mh-thread-refile}).
7030 @c -------------------------
7031 @kindex T d
7032 @findex mh-thread-delete
7033 @item T d
7034 Delete thread (@code{mh-thread-delete}).
7035 @c -------------------------
7036 @kindex T t
7037 @findex mh-toggle-threads
7038 @item T t
7039 Toggle threaded view of folder (@code{mh-toggle-threads}).
7040 @c -------------------------
7041 @kindex T n
7042 @findex mh-thread-next-sibling
7043 @item T n
7044 Display next sibling (@code{mh-thread-next-sibling}).
7045 @c -------------------------
7046 @kindex T p
7047 @findex mh-thread-previous-sibling
7048 @item T p
7049 Display previous sibling (@code{mh-thread-previous-sibling}).
7050 @c -------------------------
7051 @kindex T u
7052 @findex mh-thread-ancestor
7053 @item T u
7054 Display ancestor of current message (@code{mh-thread-ancestor}).
7055 @end table
7056
7057 @cindex @samp{mh-thread} customization group
7058 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-thread}
7059
7060 The @samp{mh-thread} customization group contains one option.
7061
7062 @vtable @code
7063 @item mh-show-threads-flag
7064 On means new folders start in threaded mode (default: @samp{off}).
7065 @end vtable
7066
7067 @findex mh-toggle-threads
7068 @kindex T t
7069 @vindex mh-large-folder
7070 @vindex mh-show-threads-flag
7071
7072 Threading large number of messages can be time consuming so the option
7073 @code{mh-show-threads-flag} is turned off by default. If you turn on
7074 this option, then threading will be done only if the number of
7075 messages being threaded is less than @code{mh-large-folder}. In any
7076 event, threading can be turned on (and off) with the command @kbd{T t}
7077 (@code{mh-toggle-threads}).
7078
7079 @findex mh-thread-ancestor
7080 @findex mh-thread-next-sibling
7081 @findex mh-thread-previous-sibling
7082 @kindex T n
7083 @kindex T p
7084 @kindex T u
7085
7086 There are a few commands to help you navigate threads. If you do not
7087 care for the way a particular thread has turned, you can move up the
7088 chain of messages with the command @kbd{T u}
7089 (@code{mh-thread-ancestor}. At any point you can use @kbd{T n}
7090 (@code{mh-thread-next-sibling} or @kbd{T p}
7091 (@code{mh-thread-previous-sibling}) to jump to the next or previous
7092 sibling, skipping the sub-threads. The command @kbd{T u} can also take
7093 a prefix argument to jump to the message that started everything.
7094
7095 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
7096 @findex mh-thread-delete
7097 @findex mh-thread-refile
7098 @kindex k
7099 @kindex T d
7100 @kindex T o
7101
7102 There are threaded equivalents for the commands that delete and refile
7103 messages. For example, @kbd{T o} (@code{mh-thread-refile}) refiles the
7104 current message and all its children. Similarly, the command @kbd{T d}
7105 (@code{mh-thread-delete}) deletes the current message and all its
7106 children. These commands do not refile or delete sibling messages.
7107 @xref{Navigating}, for a description of the similar command @kbd{k}
7108 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}).
7109
7110 @vindex mh-large-folder
7111
7112 If you find that threading is too slow, it may be that you have
7113 @code{mh-large-folder} set too high. Also, threading is one of the few
7114 features of MH-E that really benefits from compiling. If you haven't
7115 compiled MH-E, I encourage you to do so@footnote{If you're not sure if
7116 MH-E has been byte-compiled, you could try running @samp{locate
7117 mh-thread.elc} or otherwise find MH-E on your system and ensure that
7118 @file{mh-thread.elc} exists. If you have multiple versions and you
7119 find that one is compiled but the other is not, then go into your
7120 @samp{*scratch*} buffer in Emacs, enter @kbd{load-path C-j}, and
7121 ensure that the byte-compiled version appears first in the
7122 @code{load-path}. If you find that MH-E is not compiled and you
7123 installed MH-E yourself, please refer to the installation directions
7124 in the file @file{README} in the distribution.}.
7125
7126 @node Limits, Sequences, Threading, Top
7127 @chapter Limiting Display
7128
7129 @cindex limits
7130 @cindex filters
7131
7132 Another way to organize messages in a folder besides threading
7133 (@pxref{Threading}) or using full-text indexed searches
7134 (@pxref{Searching}) is by limiting the folder display to messages that
7135 are similar to the current message.
7136
7137 @table @kbd
7138 @kindex / ?
7139 @findex mh-prefix-help
7140 @item / ?
7141 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7142 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7143 @c -------------------------
7144 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence} menu item
7145 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence}
7146 @kindex / '
7147 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7148 @item / '
7149 Limit to messages in the @samp{tick} sequence
7150 (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7151 @c -------------------------
7152 @kindex / c
7153 @findex mh-narrow-to-cc
7154 @item / c
7155 Limit to messages with the same @samp{Cc:} field
7156 (@code{mh-narrow-to-cc}).
7157 @c -------------------------
7158 @kindex / m
7159 @findex mh-narrow-to-from
7160 @item / m
7161 Limit to messages with the same @samp{From:} field
7162 (@code{mh-narrow-to-from}).
7163 @c -------------------------
7164 @kindex / g
7165 @findex mh-narrow-to-range
7166 @item / g
7167 Limit to range (@code{mh-narrow-to-range}).
7168 @c -------------------------
7169 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Subject Sequence} menu item
7170 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Subject Sequence}
7171 @kindex / s
7172 @findex mh-narrow-to-subject
7173 @item / s
7174 Limit to messages with the same @samp{Subject:} field
7175 (@code{mh-narrow-to-subject}).
7176 @c -------------------------
7177 @kindex / t
7178 @findex mh-narrow-to-to
7179 @item / t
7180 Limit to messages with the same @samp{To:} field
7181 (@code{mh-narrow-to-to}).
7182 @c -------------------------
7183 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence} menu item
7184 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence}
7185 @kindex / w
7186 @findex mh-widen
7187 @item / w
7188 Remove last restriction (@code{mh-widen}).
7189 @end table
7190
7191 All of the limiting commands above refine the display in some way.
7192
7193 @cindex @command{pick}
7194 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
7195 @findex mh-narrow-to-cc
7196 @findex mh-narrow-to-from
7197 @findex mh-narrow-to-subject
7198 @findex mh-narrow-to-to
7199 @kindex / c
7200 @kindex / m
7201 @kindex / s
7202 @kindex / t
7203
7204 The commands @kbd{/ c} (@code{mh-narrow-to-cc}), @kbd{/ m}
7205 (@code{mh-narrow-to-from}), @kbd{/ s} (@code{mh-narrow-to-subject}),
7206 and @kbd{/ t} (@code{mh-narrow-to-to}) restrict the display to
7207 messages matching the content of the respective field in the current
7208 message. However, you can give any of these a prefix argument to edit
7209 the @command{pick} expression used to narrow the view@footnote{See
7210 @command{pick}(1) or the section
7211 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/finpic.html, Finding Messages with pick} in
7212 the MH book.}.
7213
7214 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7215 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7216 @cindex ticked messages, viewing
7217 @findex mh-narrow-to-range
7218 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7219 @kindex / '
7220 @kindex / g
7221
7222 You can also limit the display to messages in the @samp{tick} sequence
7223 with the command @kbd{/ '} (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7224 @xref{Sequences}, for information on putting message into the
7225 @samp{tick} sequence. Use the @kbd{/ g} (@code{mh-narrow-to-range})
7226 command to limit the display to messages in a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
7227
7228 @findex mh-widen
7229 @kindex / w
7230
7231 Each limit can be undone in turn with the @kbd{/ w} (@code{mh-widen})
7232 command. Give this command a prefix argument to remove all limits.
7233
7234 @node Sequences, Junk, Limits, Top
7235 @chapter Using Sequences
7236
7237 @cindex @samp{Sequence} menu
7238 @cindex menu, @samp{Sequence}
7239 @cindex sequences
7240
7241 For the whole scoop on MH sequences, refer to
7242 @samp{mh-sequence}(5)@footnote{See the section
7243 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/morseq.html, More About Sequences} in the MH
7244 book.}. As you've read, several of the MH-E commands can operate on a
7245 sequence, which is a shorthand for a range or group of messages. For
7246 example, you might want to forward several messages to a friend or
7247 colleague. Here's how to manipulate sequences. These commands are also
7248 available in the @samp{Sequence} menu.
7249
7250 @table @kbd
7251 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Toggle Tick Mark} menu item
7252 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Toggle Tick Mark}
7253 @kindex '
7254 @findex mh-toggle-tick
7255 @item '
7256 Toggle tick mark of range (@code{mh-toggle-tick}).
7257 @c -------------------------
7258 @kindex S ?
7259 @findex mh-prefix-help
7260 @item S ?
7261 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7262 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7263 @c -------------------------
7264 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence} menu item
7265 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence}
7266 @kindex S '
7267 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7268 @item S '
7269 Limit to ticked messages (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7270 @c -------------------------
7271 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Delete Message from Sequence...} menu item
7272 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Delete Message from Sequence...}
7273 @kindex S d
7274 @findex mh-delete-msg-from-seq
7275 @item S d
7276 Delete range from sequence (@code{mh-delete-msg-from-seq}).
7277 @c -------------------------
7278 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Delete Sequence...} menu item
7279 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Delete Sequence...}
7280 @kindex S k
7281 @findex mh-delete-seq
7282 @item S k
7283 Delete sequence (@code{mh-delete-seq}).
7284 @c -------------------------
7285 @cindex @samp{Sequence > List Sequences in Folder...} menu item
7286 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > List Sequences in Folder...}
7287 @kindex S l
7288 @findex mh-list-sequences
7289 @item S l
7290 List all sequences in folder (@code{mh-list-sequences}).
7291 @c -------------------------
7292 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Sequence...} menu item
7293 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Sequence...}
7294 @kindex S n
7295 @findex mh-narrow-to-seq
7296 @item S n
7297 Restrict display to messages in sequence (@code{mh-narrow-to-seq}).
7298 @c -------------------------
7299 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Add Message to Sequence...} menu item
7300 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Add Message to Sequence...}
7301 @kindex S p
7302 @findex mh-put-msg-in-seq
7303 @item S p
7304 Add range to sequence (@code{mh-put-msg-in-seq}).
7305 @c -------------------------
7306 @cindex @samp{Sequence > List Sequences for Message} menu item
7307 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > List Sequences for Message}
7308 @kindex S s
7309 @findex mh-msg-is-in-seq
7310 @item S s
7311 Display the sequences in which the current message appears
7312 (@code{mh-msg-is-in-seq}).
7313 @c -------------------------
7314 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence} menu item
7315 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence}
7316 @kindex S w
7317 @findex mh-widen
7318 @item S w
7319 Remove last restriction (@code{mh-widen}).
7320 @c -------------------------
7321 @findex mh-update-sequences
7322 @item M-x mh-update-sequences
7323 Flush MH-E's state out to MH@.
7324 @end table
7325
7326 @cindex @samp{mh-sequences} customization group
7327 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-sequences}
7328
7329 The @samp{mh-sequences} customization group contains the options
7330 associated with sequences.
7331
7332 @vtable @code
7333 @item mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag
7334 On means that sequences are preserved when messages are refiled
7335 (default: @samp{on}).
7336 @c -------------------------
7337 @item mh-tick-seq
7338 The name of the MH sequence for ticked messages (default: @samp{'tick}).
7339 @c -------------------------
7340 @item mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag
7341 On means flush MH sequences to disk after message is shown (default:
7342 @samp{on}).
7343 @end vtable
7344
7345 The following hook is available.
7346
7347 @vtable @code
7348 @item mh-unseen-updated-hook
7349 Hook run after the unseen sequence has been updated (default: @code{nil}).
7350 @end vtable
7351
7352 @cindex @command{pick}
7353 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
7354 @findex mh-put-msg-in-seq
7355 @kindex S p
7356
7357 To place a message in a sequence, use @kbd{S p}
7358 (@code{mh-put-msg-in-seq}). Give @kbd{S p} a range and you can add all
7359 the messages in a sequence to another sequence (for example, @kbd{C-u
7360 S p SourceSequence @key{RET} DestSequence @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
7361
7362 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7363 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7364 @cindex ticking messages
7365 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
7366 @findex mh-toggle-tick
7367 @kindex '
7368 @kindex F '
7369 @kindex S p
7370
7371 One specific use of the @kbd{S p} command is @kbd{'}
7372 (@code{mh-toggle-tick}) which adds messages to the @samp{tick}
7373 sequence. This sequence can be viewed later with the @kbd{F '}
7374 (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}) command (@pxref{Folders}).
7375
7376 @vindex mh-tick-seq
7377
7378 You can customize the option @code{mh-tick-seq} if you already use the
7379 @samp{tick} sequence for your own use. You can also disable all of the
7380 ticking functions by choosing the @samp{Disable Ticking} item but
7381 there isn't much advantage to that.
7382
7383 @cindex MH-Folder mode
7384 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
7385 @findex mh-narrow-to-seq
7386 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7387 @findex mh-widen
7388 @kindex S '
7389 @kindex S n
7390 @kindex S w
7391
7392 Once you've placed some messages in a sequence, you may wish to narrow
7393 the field of view to just those messages in the sequence you've
7394 created. To do this, use @kbd{S n} (@code{mh-narrow-to-seq}). You are
7395 prompted for the name of the sequence. What this does is show only
7396 those messages that are in the selected sequence in the MH-Folder
7397 buffer. In addition, it limits further MH-E searches to just those
7398 messages. To narrow the view to the messages in the @samp{tick}
7399 sequence, use @kbd{S '} (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}). When you want to
7400 widen the view to all your messages again, use @kbd{S w}
7401 (@code{mh-widen}).
7402
7403 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7404 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7405 @findex mh-list-sequences
7406 @findex mh-msg-is-in-seq
7407 @kindex S l
7408 @kindex S s
7409
7410 You can see which sequences in which a message appears with the
7411 command @kbd{S s} (@code{mh-msg-is-in-seq}). Use a prefix argument to
7412 display the sequences in which another message appears (as in @kbd{C-u
7413 42 S s @key{RET}}). Or, you can list all sequences in a selected
7414 folder (default is current folder) with @kbd{S l}
7415 (@code{mh-list-sequences}). The list appears in a buffer named
7416 @samp{*MH-E Sequences*} (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).
7417
7418 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Previous-Sequence:}
7419 @cindex @samp{cur} sequence
7420 @cindex @samp{Previous-Sequence:} MH profile component
7421 @cindex sequence, @samp{cur}
7422 @cindex sequence, @samp{Previous-Sequence}
7423 @vindex mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag
7424
7425 If a message is in any sequence (except
7426 @samp{Previous-Sequence:}@footnote{See @samp{mh-profile}(5)).} and
7427 @samp{cur}) when it is refiled, then it will still be in those
7428 sequences in the destination folder. If this behavior is not desired,
7429 then turn off the option @code{mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag}.
7430
7431 @findex mh-delete-msg-from-seq
7432 @findex mh-delete-seq
7433 @kindex d
7434 @kindex S d
7435 @kindex S k
7436
7437 If you want to remove a message (or range, @pxref{Ranges}) from a
7438 sequence, use @kbd{S d} (@code{mh-delete-msg-from-seq}). If you want
7439 to delete an entire sequence, use @kbd{S k} (@code{mh-delete-seq}). In
7440 the latter case you are prompted for the sequence to delete. Note that
7441 this deletes only the sequence, not the messages in the sequence. If
7442 you want to delete the messages, use @kbd{C-u d} (@pxref{Reading
7443 Mail}).
7444
7445 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
7446 @cindex @samp{cur} sequence
7447 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7448 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
7449 @cindex sequence, @samp{Unseen-Sequence}
7450 @cindex sequence, @samp{cur}
7451 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7452 @findex mh-update-sequences
7453 @kindex M-x mh-update-sequences
7454 @kindex q
7455 @kindex x
7456 @vindex mh-tick-seq
7457 @vindex mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag
7458
7459 Three sequences are maintained internally by MH-E and pushed out to MH
7460 when a message is shown. They include the sequence specified by your
7461 @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} profile component, @samp{cur}, and the
7462 sequence listed by the option @code{mh-tick-seq} which is @samp{tick}
7463 by default. If you do not like this behavior, turn off the option
7464 @code{mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag}. You can then update the
7465 state manually with the @kbd{x}, @kbd{q}, or @kbd{M-x
7466 mh-update-sequences} commands.
7467
7468 @vindex mh-seen-list
7469 @vindex mh-unseen-updated-hook
7470
7471 The hook @code{mh-unseen-updated-hook} is run after the unseen
7472 sequence has been updated. The variable @code{mh-seen-list} can be
7473 used by this hook to obtain the list of messages which were removed
7474 from the unseen sequence.
7475
7476 @cindex @command{mark}
7477 @cindex MH commands, @command{mark}
7478 @kindex S n
7479 @kindex S w
7480
7481 With the exceptions of @kbd{S n} and @kbd{S w}, the underlying MH
7482 command dealing with sequences is @command{mark}@footnote{See the
7483 section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mmbwm.html, Make Message Bookmarks
7484 with mark} in the MH book.}.
7485
7486 @node Junk, Miscellaneous, Sequences, Top
7487 @chapter Dealing With Junk Mail
7488
7489 @cindex Marshall Rose
7490 @cindex junk mail
7491 @cindex spam
7492
7493 Marshall Rose once wrote a paper on MH entitled, @cite{How to process
7494 200 messages a day and still get some real work done}. This chapter
7495 could be entitled, @cite{How to process 1000 spams a day and still get
7496 some real work done}.
7497
7498 @cindex blacklisting
7499 @cindex ham
7500 @cindex viruses
7501 @cindex whitelisting
7502 @cindex worms
7503
7504 We use the terms @dfn{junk mail} and @dfn{spam} interchangeably for
7505 any unwanted message which includes spam, @dfn{viruses}, and
7506 @dfn{worms}. The opposite of spam is @dfn{ham}. The act of classifying
7507 a sender as one who sends junk mail is called @dfn{blacklisting}; the
7508 opposite is called @dfn{whitelisting}.
7509
7510 @table @kbd
7511 @kindex J ?
7512 @findex mh-prefix-help
7513 @item J ?
7514 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7515 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7516 @c -------------------------
7517 @kindex J b
7518 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7519 @item J b
7520 Blacklist range as spam (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}).
7521 @c -------------------------
7522 @kindex J w
7523 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7524 @item J w
7525 Whitelist range as ham (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}).
7526 @c -------------------------
7527 @item @code{mh-spamassassin-identify-spammers}
7528 Identify spammers who are repeat offenders.
7529 @end table
7530
7531 @cindex @samp{mh-junk} customization group
7532 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-junk}
7533
7534 The following table lists the options from the @samp{mh-junk}
7535 customization group.
7536
7537 @vtable @code
7538 @item mh-junk-background
7539 If on, spam programs are run in background (default: @samp{off}).
7540 @c -------------------------
7541 @item mh-junk-disposition
7542 Disposition of junk mail (default: @samp{Delete Spam}).
7543 @c -------------------------
7544 @item mh-junk-program
7545 Spam program that MH-E should use (default: @samp{Auto-detect}).
7546 @end vtable
7547
7548 @cindex SpamProbe
7549 @cindex Spamassassin
7550 @cindex bogofilter
7551 @cindex spam filters, SpamProbe
7552 @cindex spam filters, Spamassassin
7553 @cindex spam filters, bogofilter
7554
7555 MH-E depends on @uref{http://spamassassin.apache.org/, SpamAssassin},
7556 @uref{http://bogofilter.sourceforge.net/, bogofilter}, or
7557 @uref{http://spamprobe.sourceforge.net/, SpamProbe} to throw the dreck
7558 away. This chapter describes briefly how to configure these programs
7559 to work well with MH-E and how to use MH-E's interface that provides
7560 continuing education for these programs.
7561
7562 @vindex mh-junk-program
7563
7564 The default setting of the option @code{mh-junk-program} is
7565 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose one
7566 of SpamAssassin, bogofilter, or SpamProbe in that order. If, for
7567 example, you have both SpamAssassin and bogofilter installed and you
7568 want to use bogofilter, then you can set this option to
7569 @samp{Bogofilter}.
7570
7571 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7572 @kindex J b
7573 @vindex mh-junk-disposition
7574
7575 The command @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) trains the spam
7576 program in use with the content of the range (@pxref{Ranges}) and then
7577 handles the message(s) as specified by the option
7578 @code{mh-junk-disposition}. By default, this option is set to
7579 @samp{Delete Spam} but you can also specify the name of the folder
7580 which is useful for building a corpus of spam for training purposes.
7581
7582 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7583 @kindex J w
7584
7585 In contrast, the command @kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist})
7586 reclassifies a range of messages (@pxref{Ranges}) as ham if it were
7587 incorrectly classified as spam. It then refiles the message into the
7588 @file{+inbox} folder.
7589
7590 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7591 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7592 @findex call-process
7593 @vindex mh-junk-background
7594
7595 By default, the programs are run in the foreground, but this can be
7596 slow when junking large numbers of messages. If you have enough memory
7597 or don't junk that many messages at the same time, you might try
7598 turning on the option @code{mh-junk-background}. @footnote{Note that
7599 the option @code{mh-junk-background} is used as the @code{display}
7600 argument in the call to @code{call-process}. Therefore, turning on
7601 this option means setting its value to @samp{0}. You can also set its
7602 value to @samp{t} to direct the programs' output to the @samp{*MH-E
7603 Log*} buffer; this may be useful for debugging.}
7604
7605 The following sections discuss the various counter-spam measures that
7606 MH-E can work with.
7607
7608 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
7609 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
7610
7611 @subheading SpamAssassin
7612
7613 @cindex Spamassassin
7614 @cindex spam filters, Spamassassin
7615
7616 SpamAssassin is one of the more popular spam filtering programs. Get
7617 it from your local distribution or from the
7618 @uref{http://spamassassin.apache.org/, SpamAssassin web site}.
7619
7620 To use SpamAssassin, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7621
7622 @cindex @command{spamc}
7623 @cindex @samp{X-Spam-Level:} header field
7624 @cindex @samp{X-Spam-Status:} header field
7625 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Spam-Level:}
7626 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Spam-Status:}
7627
7628 @smallexample
7629 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7630 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7631
7632 # Fight spam with SpamAssassin.
7633 :0fw
7634 | spamc
7635
7636 # Anything with a spam level of 10 or more is junked immediately.
7637 :0:
7638 * ^X-Spam-Level: ..........
7639 /dev/null
7640
7641 :0:
7642 * ^X-Spam-Status: Yes
7643 spam/.
7644 @end smallexample
7645
7646 If you don't use @command{spamc}, use @samp{spamassassin -P -a}.
7647
7648 Note that one of the recipes above throws away messages with a score
7649 greater than or equal to 10. Here's how you can determine a value that
7650 works best for you.
7651
7652 First, run @samp{spamassassin -t} on every mail message in your
7653 archive and use @command{gnumeric} to verify that the average plus the
7654 standard deviation of good mail is under 5, the SpamAssassin default
7655 for ``spam''.
7656
7657 Using @command{gnumeric}, sort the messages by score and view the
7658 messages with the highest score. Determine the score which encompasses
7659 all of your interesting messages and add a couple of points to be
7660 conservative. Add that many dots to the @samp{X-Spam-Level:} header
7661 field above to send messages with that score down the drain.
7662
7663 In the example above, messages with a score of 5-9 are set aside in
7664 the @samp{+spam} folder for later review. The major weakness of
7665 rules-based filters is a plethora of false positives so it is
7666 worthwhile to check.
7667
7668 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7669 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7670 @kindex J b
7671 @kindex J w
7672
7673 If SpamAssassin classifies a message incorrectly, or is unsure, you can
7674 use the MH-E commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and
7675 @kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}).
7676
7677 @cindex @command{sa-learn}
7678 @cindex @file{.spamassassin/user_prefs}
7679 @cindex files, @file{.spamassassin/user_prefs}
7680
7681 The command @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) adds a
7682 @samp{blacklist_from} entry to @file{~/spamassassin/user_prefs},
7683 deletes the message, and sends the message to the Razor, so that
7684 others might not see this spam. If the @command{sa-learn} command is
7685 available, the message is also recategorized as spam.
7686
7687 The command@kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) adds a
7688 @samp{whitelist_from} rule to @samp{~/.spamassassin/user_prefs}. If
7689 the @command{sa-learn} command is available, the message is also
7690 recategorized as ham.
7691
7692 Over time, you'll observe that the same host or domain occurs
7693 repeatedly in the @samp{blacklist_from} entries, so you might think
7694 that you could avoid future spam by blacklisting all mail from a
7695 particular domain. The utility function
7696 @code{mh-spamassassin-identify-spammers} helps you do precisely that.
7697 This function displays a frequency count of the hosts and domains in
7698 the @samp{blacklist_from} entries from the last blank line in
7699 @file{~/.spamassassin/user_prefs} to the end of the file. This
7700 information can be used so that you can replace multiple
7701 @samp{blacklist_from} entries with a single wildcard entry such as:
7702
7703 @smallexample
7704 blacklist_from *@@*amazingoffersdirect2u.com
7705 @end smallexample
7706
7707 In versions of SpamAssassin (2.50 and on) that support a Bayesian
7708 classifier, @kbd{J b} @code{(mh-junk-blacklist}) uses the program
7709 @command{sa-learn} to recategorize the message as spam. Neither MH-E,
7710 nor SpamAssassin, rebuilds the database after adding words, so you
7711 will need to run @samp{sa-learn --rebuild} periodically. This can be
7712 done by adding the following to your @file{crontab}:
7713
7714 @smallexample
7715 0 * * * * sa-learn --rebuild > /dev/null 2>&1
7716 @end smallexample
7717
7718 @subheading Bogofilter
7719
7720 @cindex bogofilter
7721 @cindex spam filters, bogofilter
7722
7723 Bogofilter is a Bayesian spam filtering program. Get it from your
7724 local distribution or from the
7725 @uref{http://bogofilter.sourceforge.net/, bogofilter web site}.
7726
7727 Bogofilter is taught by running:
7728
7729 @smallexample
7730 bogofilter -n < good-message
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 on every good message, and
7734
7735 @smallexample
7736 bogofilter -s < spam-message
7737 @end smallexample
7738
7739 @cindex full training
7740
7741 on every spam message. This is called a @dfn{full training}; three
7742 other training methods are described in the FAQ that is distributed
7743 with bogofilter. Note that most Bayesian filters need 1000 to 5000 of
7744 each type of message to start doing a good job.
7745
7746 To use bogofilter, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7747
7748 @cindex @samp{X-Bogosity:} header field
7749 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Bogosity:}
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7753 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7754
7755 # Fight spam with Bogofilter.
7756 :0fw
7757 | bogofilter -3 -e -p
7758
7759 :0:
7760 * ^X-Bogosity: Yes, tests=bogofilter
7761 spam/.
7762
7763 :0:
7764 * ^X-Bogosity: Unsure, tests=bogofilter
7765 spam/unsure/.
7766 @end smallexample
7767
7768 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7769 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7770 @kindex J b
7771 @kindex J w
7772
7773 If bogofilter classifies a message incorrectly, or is unsure, you can
7774 use the MH-E commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and @kbd{J
7775 w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) to update bogofilter's training.
7776
7777 The @cite{Bogofilter FAQ} suggests that you run the following
7778 occasionally to shrink the database:
7779
7780 @smallexample
7781 bogoutil -d wordlist.db | bogoutil -l wordlist.db.new
7782 mv wordlist.db wordlist.db.prv
7783 mv wordlist.db.new wordlist.db
7784 @end smallexample
7785
7786 The @cite{Bogofilter tuning HOWTO} describes how you can fine-tune
7787 bogofilter.
7788
7789 @subheading SpamProbe
7790
7791 @cindex SpamProbe
7792 @cindex spam filters, SpamProbe
7793
7794 SpamProbe is a Bayesian spam filtering program. Get it from your local
7795 distribution or from the @uref{http://spamprobe.sourceforge.net,
7796 SpamProbe web site}.
7797
7798 To use SpamProbe, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7799
7800 @cindex @command{formail}
7801 @cindex @samp{X-SpamProbe:} header field
7802 @cindex header field, @samp{X-SpamProbe:}
7803
7804 @smallexample
7805 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7806 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7807
7808 # Fight spam with SpamProbe.
7809 :0
7810 SCORE=| spamprobe receive
7811
7812 :0 wf
7813 | formail -I "X-SpamProbe: $SCORE"
7814
7815 :0:
7816 *^X-SpamProbe: SPAM
7817 spam/.
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7821 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7822 @kindex J b
7823 @kindex J w
7824
7825 If SpamProbe classifies a message incorrectly, you can use the MH-E
7826 commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and @kbd{J w}
7827 (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) to update SpamProbe's training.
7828
7829 @subheading Other Things You Can Do
7830
7831 There are a couple of things that you can add to @file{~/.procmailrc}
7832 in order to filter out a lot of spam and viruses. The first is to
7833 eliminate any message with a Windows executable (which is most likely
7834 a virus). The second is to eliminate mail in character sets that you
7835 can't read.
7836
7837 @cindex @samp{Content-Transfer-Encoding:} header field
7838 @cindex @samp{Content-Type:} header field
7839 @cindex @samp{Subject:} header field
7840 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Transfer-Encoding:}
7841 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Type:}
7842 @cindex header field, @samp{Subject:}
7843
7844 @smallexample
7845 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7846 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7847
7848 #
7849 # Filter messages with win32 executables/virii.
7850 #
7851 # These attachments are base64 and have a TVqQAAMAAAAEAAAA//8AALg
7852 # pattern. The string "this program cannot be run in MS-DOS mode"
7853 # encoded in base64 is 4fug4AtAnNIbg and helps to avoid false
7854 # positives (Roland Smith via Pete from the bogofilter mailing list).
7855 #
7856 :0 B:
7857 * ^Content-Transfer-Encoding:.*base64
7858 * ^TVqQAAMAAAAEAAAA//8AALg
7859 * 4fug4AtAnNIbg
7860 spam/exe/.
7861
7862 #
7863 # Filter mail in unreadable character sets (from the Bogofilter FAQ).
7864 #
7865 UNREADABLE='[^?"]*big5|iso-2022-jp|ISO-2022-KR|euc-kr|gb2312|ks_c_5601-1987'
7866
7867 :0:
7868 * 1^0 $ ^Subject:.*=\?($UNREADABLE)
7869 * 1^0 $ ^Content-Type:.*charset="?($UNREADABLE)
7870 spam/unreadable/.
7871
7872 :0:
7873 * ^Content-Type:.*multipart
7874 * B ?? $ ^Content-Type:.*^?.*charset="?($UNREADABLE)
7875 spam/unreadable/.
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878 @node Miscellaneous, Scan Line Formats, Junk, Top
7879 @chapter Miscellaneous Commands, Variables, and Buffers
7880
7881 This chapter covers the following command and the various MH-E
7882 buffers,
7883
7884 @ftable @code
7885 @item mh-version
7886 Display version information about MH-E and the MH mail handling
7887 system.
7888 @end ftable
7889
7890 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7891 @cindex MH-E version
7892 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7893 @cindex version
7894 @kindex M-x mh-version
7895
7896 One command worth noting is @kbd{M-x mh-version}. You can compare the
7897 version this command prints to the latest release (@pxref{Getting
7898 MH-E}). The output of @kbd{M-x mh-version}, found in a buffer named
7899 @samp{*MH-E Info*}, should usually be included with any bug report you
7900 submit (@pxref{Bug Reports}).
7901
7902 @subheading MH-E Buffers
7903
7904 Besides the MH-Folder, MH-Show, and MH-Letter buffers, MH-E creates
7905 several other buffers. They are:
7906
7907 @table @samp
7908 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
7909 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
7910 @findex mh-list-folders
7911 @item *MH-E Folders*
7912 @kindex F l
7913 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{F l} (@code{mh-list-folders}).
7914 @xref{Folders}.
7915 @c -------------------------
7916 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Help*}
7917 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Help*}
7918 @findex mh-help
7919 @item *MH-E Help*
7920 @kindex ?
7921 @kindex C-c ?
7922 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{?} (@code{mh-help}) and
7923 @kbd{C-c ?} in MH-Letter mode. @xref{Using This Manual}.
7924 @c -------------------------
7925 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7926 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7927 @item *MH-E Info*
7928 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{M-x mh-version @key{RET}}.
7929 @c -------------------------
7930 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7931 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7932 @item *MH-E Log*
7933 This buffer contains the last 100 lines of the output of the various
7934 MH commands.
7935 @c -------------------------
7936 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
7937 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
7938 @item *MH-E Mail Delivery*
7939 This buffer contains the transcript of a mail delivery. @xref{Sending
7940 Message}.
7941 @c -------------------------
7942 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
7943 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
7944 @findex mh-check-whom
7945 @item *MH-E Recipients*
7946 @kindex C-c C-w
7947 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{C-c C-w}
7948 (@code{mh-check-whom}) and is killed when draft is sent.
7949 @xref{Checking Recipients}.
7950 @c -------------------------
7951 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7952 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7953 @item *MH-E Sequences*
7954 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{S l}
7955 (@code{mh-list-sequences}). @xref{Sequences}.
7956 @c -------------------------
7957 @cindex @samp{*mh-temp*}
7958 @cindex buffers, @samp{*mh-temp*}
7959 @item *mh-temp*
7960 This is a scratch, ephemeral, buffer used by MH-E functions. Note that
7961 it is hidden because the first character in the name is a space.
7962 You'll generally not have any need for this buffer.
7963 @end table
7964
7965 @node Scan Line Formats, Procmail, Miscellaneous, Top
7966 @appendix Scan Line Formats
7967
7968 @cindex scan line formats
7969
7970 This appendix discusses how MH-E creates, parses, and manipulates scan
7971 lines. If you have your own MH scan or inc format files, you
7972 @strong{can} teach MH-E how to handle them, but it isn't easy as
7973 you'll see.
7974
7975 @cindex @samp{mh-scan-line-formats} customization group
7976 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-scan-line-formats}
7977
7978 This table lists the options in the @samp{mh-scan-line-formats}
7979 customization group.
7980
7981 @vtable @code
7982 @item mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
7983 On means that the message number width is determined dynamically
7984 (default: @samp{on}).
7985 @c -------------------------
7986 @item mh-scan-format-file
7987 Specifies the format file to pass to the scan program (default:
7988 @samp{Use MH-E scan Format}).
7989 @c -------------------------
7990 @item mh-scan-prog
7991 Program used to scan messages (default: @code{"scan"}).
7992 @end vtable
7993
7994 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
7995
7996 There are a couple of caveats when creating your own scan format file.
7997 First, MH-E will not work if your scan lines do not include message
7998 numbers. It will work poorly if you don't dedicate a column for
7999 showing the current message and notations. You won't be able to use
8000 the option @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} or the threading features
8001 (@pxref{Threading}).
8002
8003 @cindex message numbers
8004 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
8005 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8006 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8007
8008 If you've created your own format to handle long message numbers,
8009 you'll be pleased to know you no longer need it since MH-E adapts its
8010 internal format based upon the largest message number if
8011 @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} is on (the default). If you prefer
8012 fixed-width message numbers, turn off @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}
8013 and call @code{mh-set-cmd-note} with the width specified by your
8014 format file (see @code{mh-scan-format-file}). For example, the default
8015 width is 4, so you would use @samp{(mh-set-cmd-note 4)}.
8016
8017 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8018 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8019 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8020 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8021
8022 The default setting for @code{mh-scan-format-file} is @samp{Use MH-E
8023 scan Format}. This means that the format string will be taken from the
8024 either @code{mh-scan-format-mh} or @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} depending
8025 on whether MH or nmh (or GNU mailutils) is in use. This setting also
8026 enables you to turn on the option @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}.
8027 You can also set this option to @samp{Use Default scan Format} to get
8028 the same output as you would get if you ran @command{scan} from the
8029 shell. If you have a format file that you want MH-E to use but not MH,
8030 you can set this option to @samp{Specify a scan Format File} and enter
8031 the name of your format file.
8032
8033 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8034 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8035 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8036
8037 The scan format that MH-E uses when @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set
8038 to its default of @samp{Use MH-E scan Format} is held in the variables
8039 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} and @code{mh-scan-format-mh} depending on
8040 whether you are using nmh (or GNU mailutils) or not. Typically, you
8041 create your own format files rather than modifying these variables.
8042 The value of @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} is:
8043
8044 @smallexample
8045 (concat
8046 "%4(msg)"
8047 "%<(cur)+%| %>"
8048 "%<@{replied@}-"
8049 "%?(nonnull(comp@{to@}))%<(mymbox@{to@})t%>"
8050 "%?(nonnull(comp@{cc@}))%<(mymbox@{cc@})c%>"
8051 "%?(nonnull(comp@{bcc@}))%<(mymbox@{bcc@})b%>"
8052 "%?(nonnull(comp@{newsgroups@}))n%>"
8053 "%<(zero) %>"
8054 "%02(mon@{date@})/%02(mday@{date@})%<@{date@} %|*%>"
8055 "%<(mymbox@{from@})%<@{to@}To:%14(decode(friendly@{to@}))%>%>"
8056 "%<(zero)%17(decode(friendly@{from@}))%> "
8057 "%(decode@{subject@})%<@{body@}<<%@{body@}%>")
8058 @end smallexample
8059
8060 @cindex decoding RFC 2047
8061 @cindex RFC 2047, decoding
8062 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8063
8064 The setting for @code{mh-scan-format-mh} is similar, except that MH
8065 doesn't have the function @code{decode} (which is used to decode RFC
8066 2047 encodings).
8067
8068 @cindex notations, scan line
8069 @cindex scan line notations
8070
8071 These strings are passed to the @command{scan} program via the
8072 @option{-format} argument. The formats are identical to the defaults
8073 except that additional hints for fontification have been added to the
8074 existing notations in the fifth column (remember that in Emacs, the
8075 columns start at 0). The values of the fifth column, in priority
8076 order, are: @samp{-} if the message has been replied to, @samp{t} if
8077 an address in the @samp{To:} field matches one of the mailboxes of the
8078 current user, @samp{c} if the @samp{Cc:} field matches, @samp{b} if
8079 the @samp{Bcc:} field matches, and @samp{n} if a non-empty
8080 @samp{Newsgroups:} field is present.
8081
8082 @cindex @command{scan}
8083 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
8084 @vindex mh-progs
8085 @vindex mh-scan-prog
8086
8087 The name of the program that generates a listing of one line per
8088 message is held in @code{mh-scan-prog} (default: @code{"scan"}).
8089 Unless this variable contains an absolute pathname, it is assumed to
8090 be in the @code{mh-progs} directory (@pxref{Getting Started}). You may
8091 link another program to @command{scan} (see @samp{mh-profile}(5)) to
8092 produce a different type of listing@footnote{See the section
8093 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/faswsprs.html, Find and Specify with scan
8094 pick Ranges Sequences} in the MH book.}.
8095
8096 @cindex regular expressions, scan line formats
8097 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
8098 @findex setq
8099
8100 If you change the format of the scan lines you'll need to tell MH-E
8101 how to parse the new format. As you will see, quite a lot of variables
8102 are involved to do that. Use @kbd{M-x apropos @key{RET}
8103 mh-scan.*regexp @key{RET}} to obtain a list of these variables. You
8104 will also have to call @code{mh-set-cmd-note} if your notations are
8105 not in column 4 (columns in Emacs start with 0). Note that unlike most
8106 of the user options described in this manual, these are variables and
8107 must be set with @code{setq} instead of in a customization buffer. For
8108 help with regular expressions, see
8109 @ifnothtml
8110 @ref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
8111 GNU Emacs Manual}.
8112 @end ifnothtml
8113 @ifhtml
8114 section
8115 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
8116 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
8117 @end ifhtml
8118
8119 The first variable has to do with pruning out garbage.
8120
8121 @vtable @code
8122 @cindex @command{inc}
8123 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
8124 @cindex @command{scan}
8125 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
8126 @item mh-scan-valid-regexp
8127 This regular expression describes a valid scan line. This is used to
8128 eliminate error messages that are occasionally produced by
8129 @command{inc}@footnote{See the section
8130 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
8131 prev} in the MH book.} or @command{scan} (default: @code{"^ *[0-9]"}).
8132 @end vtable
8133
8134 Next, many variables control how the scan lines are parsed.
8135
8136 @vtable @code
8137 @vindex mh-folder-body
8138 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8139 @item mh-scan-body-regexp
8140 This regular expression matches the message body fragment. Note that
8141 the default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects
8142 this expression to contain at least one parenthesized expression which
8143 matches the body text as in the default of
8144 @code{"\\(<<\\([^\n]+\\)?\\)"}. If this regular expression is not
8145 correct, the body fragment will not be highlighted with the face
8146 @code{mh-folder-body}.
8147 @c -------------------------
8148 @vindex mh-folder-cur-msg-number
8149 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8150 @vindex mh-note-cur
8151 @item mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp
8152 This regular expression matches the current message. It must match
8153 from the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8154 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8155 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8156 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\+\\).*"}}. This
8157 expression includes the leading space and current message marker
8158 @samp{+} within the parenthesis since it looks better to highlight
8159 these items as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8160 @code{mh-folder-cur-msg-number}. This regular expression should be
8161 correct as it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8162 @code{mh-note-cur}.
8163 @c -------------------------
8164 @vindex mh-folder-date
8165 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8166 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
8167 @item mh-scan-date-regexp
8168 This regular expression matches a valid date. It must @strong{not} be
8169 anchored to the beginning or the end of the line. Note that the
8170 default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this
8171 expression to contain only one parenthesized expression which matches
8172 the date field as in the default of
8173 @code{"\\([0-9][0-9]/[0-9][0-9]\\)"}. If this regular expression is
8174 not correct, the date will not be highlighted with the face
8175 @code{mh-folder-date}.
8176 @c -------------------------
8177 @vindex mh-folder-deleted
8178 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8179 @vindex mh-note-deleted
8180 @item mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp
8181 This regular expression matches deleted messages. It must match from
8182 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8183 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8184 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8185 as in the default of @code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)D"}. This expression
8186 includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it looks
8187 better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8188 @code{mh-folder-deleted}. This regular expression should be correct as
8189 it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8190 @code{mh-note-deleted}.
8191 @c -------------------------
8192 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8193 @vindex mh-folder-msg-number
8194 @item mh-scan-good-msg-regexp
8195 This regular expression matches ``good'' messages. It must match from
8196 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8197 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8198 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8199 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)[^D^0-9]"}}. This
8200 expression includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it
8201 looks better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with
8202 the face @code{mh-folder-msg-number}. This regular expression should
8203 be correct as it is needed by non-fontification functions.
8204 @c -------------------------
8205 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8206 @item mh-scan-msg-format-regexp
8207 This regular expression finds the message number width in a scan
8208 format. Note that the message number must be placed in a parenthesized
8209 expression as in the default of @code{"%\\([0-9]*\\)(msg)"}. This
8210 variable is only consulted if @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set to
8211 @samp{Use MH-E scan Format}.
8212 @c -------------------------
8213 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8214 @item mh-scan-msg-format-string
8215 This is a format string for the width of the message number in a scan
8216 format. Use @samp{0%d} for zero-filled message numbers. This variable
8217 is only consulted if @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set to @samp{Use
8218 MH-E scan Format} (default: @code{"%d"}).
8219 @c -------------------------
8220 @item mh-scan-msg-number-regexp
8221 This regular expression extracts the message number. It must match
8222 from the beginning of the line. Note that the message number must be
8223 placed in a parenthesized expression as in the default of @w{@code{"^
8224 *\\([0-9]+\\)"}}.
8225 @c -------------------------
8226 @item mh-scan-msg-overflow-regexp
8227 This regular expression matches overflowed message numbers (default:
8228 @code{"^[?0-9][0-9]"}).
8229 @c -------------------------
8230 @item mh-scan-msg-search-regexp
8231 This regular expression matches a particular message. It is a format
8232 string; use @samp{%d} to represent the location of the message number
8233 within the expression as in the default of @code{"^[^0-9]*%d[^0-9]"}.
8234 @c -------------------------
8235 @vindex mh-folder-address
8236 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8237 @vindex mh-folder-to
8238 @item mh-scan-rcpt-regexp
8239 This regular expression specifies the recipient in messages you sent.
8240 Note that the default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords}
8241 expects this expression to contain two parenthesized expressions. The
8242 first is expected to match the @samp{To:} that the default scan format
8243 file generates. The second is expected to match the recipient's name
8244 as in the default of @code{"\\(To:\\)\\(..............\\)"}. If this
8245 regular expression is not correct, the @samp{To:} string will not be
8246 highlighted with the face @code{mh-folder-to} and the recipient will not be
8247 highlighted with the face @code{mh-folder-address}.
8248 @c -------------------------
8249 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8250 @vindex mh-folder-refiled
8251 @vindex mh-note-refiled
8252 @item mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp
8253 This regular expression matches refiled messages. It must match from
8254 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8255 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8256 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8257 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)\\^"}}. This expression
8258 includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it looks
8259 better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8260 @code{mh-folder-refiled}. This regular expression should be correct as
8261 it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8262 @code{mh-note-refiled}.
8263 @c -------------------------
8264 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8265 @vindex mh-folder-sent-to-me-sender
8266 @vindex mh-mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint
8267 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8268 @item mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
8269 This regular expression matches messages sent to us. Note that the
8270 default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this
8271 expression to contain at least two parenthesized expressions. The
8272 first should match the fontification hint (see
8273 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh}) and the second should match the user name
8274 as in the default of
8275 @w{@code{"^ *[0-9]+.\\([bct]\\).....[ ]*\\(..................\\)"}}.
8276 If this regular expression is not correct, the notation hints will not
8277 be highlighted with the face @code{mh-mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint} and
8278 the sender will not be highlighted with the face
8279 @code{mh-folder-sent-to-me-sender}.
8280 @c -------------------------
8281 @vindex mh-folder-followup
8282 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8283 @vindex mh-folder-subject
8284 @item mh-scan-subject-regexp
8285 This regular expression matches the subject. It must match from the
8286 beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8287 @samp{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8288 at least three parenthesized expressions. The first is expected to
8289 match the @samp{Re:} string, if any, and is highlighted with the face
8290 @code{mh-folder-followup}. The second matches an optional bracketed
8291 number after @samp{Re:}, such as in @samp{Re[2]:} (and is thus a
8292 sub-expression of the first expression). The third is expected to
8293 match the subject line itself which is highlighted with the face
8294 @code{mh-folder-subject}. For example, the default is
8295 @w{@code{"^ *[0-9]+........[ ]*...................}}@*
8296 @w{@code{\\([Rr][Ee]\\(\\[[0-9]+\\]\\)?:\\s-*\\)*\\([^<\n]*\\)"}}.
8297 This regular expression should be correct as it is needed by
8298 non-fontification functions. Note that this example is broken up on
8299 two lines for readability, but is actually a single string.
8300 @end vtable
8301
8302 Finally, there are a slew of variables that control how MH-E annotates
8303 the scan lines.
8304
8305 @vtable @code
8306 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
8307 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8308 @item mh-cmd-note
8309 Column for notations (default: 4). This variable should be set with
8310 the function @code{mh-set-cmd-note}. This variable may be updated
8311 dynamically if @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} is on. The following
8312 variables contain the notational characters. Note that columns in
8313 Emacs start with 0.
8314 @c -------------------------
8315 @item mh-note-copied
8316 Messages that have been copied are marked by this character (default:
8317 @code{?C}).
8318 @c -------------------------
8319 @vindex mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp
8320 @item mh-note-cur
8321 The current message (in MH, not in MH-E) is marked by this character
8322 (default: @code{?+}). See also @code{mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp}.
8323 @c -------------------------
8324 @vindex mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp
8325 @item mh-note-deleted
8326 Messages that have been deleted are marked by this character (default:
8327 @code{?D}). See also @code{mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp}.
8328 @c -------------------------
8329 @item mh-note-dist
8330 Messages that have been redistributed are marked by this character
8331 (default: @code{?R}).
8332 @c -------------------------
8333 @item mh-note-forw
8334 Messages that have been forwarded are marked by this character
8335 (default: @code{?F}).
8336 @c -------------------------
8337 @item mh-note-printed
8338 Messages that have been printed are marked by this character (default:
8339 @code{?P}).
8340 @c -------------------------
8341 @vindex mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp
8342 @item mh-note-refiled
8343 Messages that have been refiled are marked by this character (default:
8344 @code{?^}). See also @code{mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp}.
8345 @c -------------------------
8346 @item mh-note-repl
8347 Messages that have been replied to are marked by this character
8348 (default: @code{?-}).
8349 @c -------------------------
8350 @item mh-note-seq
8351 Messages in a user-defined sequence are marked by this character
8352 (default: @code{?%}). Messages in the @samp{search} sequence are
8353 marked by this character as well.
8354 @end vtable
8355
8356 For example, let's say I have the following in @file{scan.format}
8357 which displays the sender, the subject, and the message number. This
8358 format places a @samp{+} after the message number for the current
8359 message according to MH; it also uses that column for notations.
8360
8361 @smallexample
8362 %20(decode(friendly@{from@})) %50(decode@{subject@}) %4(msg)%<(cur)+%| %>
8363 @end smallexample
8364
8365 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8366 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8367 @vindex mh-scan-format-file, example
8368
8369 The first thing you have to do is tell MH-E to use this file.
8370 Customize @code{mh-scan-format-file} and set its value to @samp{Use
8371 Default scan Format}. If you didn't get already turn off
8372 @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}, you'll need to do that first.
8373
8374 Next, tell MH-E what a valid scan line looks like so that you can at
8375 least display the output of scan in your MH-Folder buffer.
8376
8377 @vindex mh-scan-valid-regexp, example
8378
8379 @smalllisp
8380 (setq mh-scan-valid-regexp "[0-9]+[+D^ ]$")
8381 @end smalllisp
8382
8383 Now, in order to get rid of the @samp{Cursor not pointing to message}
8384 message, you need to tell MH-E how to access the message number. You
8385 should also see why MH-E requires that you include a message number in
8386 the first place.
8387
8388 @vindex mh-scan-msg-number-regexp, example
8389 @vindex mh-scan-msg-search-regexp, example
8390
8391 @smalllisp
8392 (setq mh-scan-msg-number-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)[+D^ ]$")
8393 (setq mh-scan-msg-search-regexp " %d[+D^ ]$")
8394 @end smalllisp
8395
8396 In order to get the next and previous commands working, add this.
8397
8398 @vindex mh-scan-good-msg-regexp, example
8399
8400 @smalllisp
8401 (setq mh-scan-good-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)[+D^ ]$")
8402 @end smalllisp
8403
8404 Note that the current message isn't marked with a @samp{+} when moving
8405 between the next and previous messages. Here is the code required to
8406 get this working.
8407
8408 @vindex set-mh-cmd-note, example
8409 @vindex mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp, example
8410
8411 @smalllisp
8412 (set-mh-cmd-note 76)
8413 (setq mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)\\+$")
8414 @end smalllisp
8415
8416 Finally, add the following to delete and refile messages.
8417
8418 @vindex mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp, example
8419 @vindex mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp, example
8420
8421 @smalllisp
8422 (setq mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)D$")
8423 (setq mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)\\^$")
8424 @end smalllisp
8425
8426 This is just a bare minimum; it's best to adjust all of the regular
8427 expressions to ensure that MH-E and highlighting perform well.
8428
8429 @node Procmail, Odds and Ends, Scan Line Formats, Top
8430 @appendix Reading Mailing Lists Effectively
8431
8432 @cindex @command{procmail}
8433 @cindex @command{slocal}
8434 @cindex Gnus
8435 @cindex MH commands, @command{slocal}
8436 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
8437 @cindex mailing lists, reading
8438
8439 This appendix explains how to use @uref{http://www.procmail.org/,
8440 procmail} to file mail from mailing lists into folders which can then
8441 be read easily with MH-E@footnote{The MH equivalent, @command{slocal},
8442 can be used as well, but procmail is more flexible and more packages
8443 exist for procmail than for slocal.}. Some mailing lists have such
8444 high traffic that Gnus must be used and I discuss how to use Gnus
8445 side-by-side with MH-E.
8446
8447 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
8448 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
8449
8450 First, I'll describe how to put mail from your mailing lists directly
8451 into an MH folder using @command{procmail}. First, add the following
8452 to @file{~/.procmailrc}. While the logging variables aren't strictly
8453 necessary, they are extremely useful.
8454
8455 @smallexample
8456 [1] # Update PATH so procmail can find myrcvstore, rcvstore and mhparam.
8457 [2] PATH=$PATH:/usr/lib/mh:/usr/bin/mh:$HOME/bin
8458 [3]
8459 [4] # Point LOGFILE at the actual log file.
8460 [5] LOGFILE=$HOME/.procmail.log
8461 [6]
8462 [7] # This setting provides just the right amount of information.
8463 [8] LOGABSTRACT=all
8464 [9]
8465 [10] # Uncomment the following line to see how your patterns match.
8466 [11] #VERBOSE=yes
8467 [12]
8468 [13] # Place mail sent to any MH-E mailing list in +mh-e.
8469 [14] :0 w: mh-e$LOCKEXT
8470 [15] * ^TO.*mh-e-.*@.*sourceforge.net
8471 [16] | myrcvstore -create +mh-e
8472 @end smallexample
8473
8474 @cindex @command{rcvstore}
8475 @cindex MH commands, @command{rcvstore}
8476
8477 Line 14 creates a lock file in your mail directory based upon the name
8478 of the folder. This is done because @command{rcvstore} does not
8479 perform locking. While this lock file will prevent @command{procmail}
8480 from writing to a folder concurrently, there is a slight chance that
8481 you might lose a message if you're performing operations on a folder
8482 at the same time @command{rcvstore} is placing a message there. You
8483 have been warned. Now that that disclaimer is out of the way, note
8484 that I've been using this set-up for over a decade and haven't lost
8485 anything to my knowledge@footnote{See
8486 @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/bugs/?func=detailbug&bug_id=4361&group_id=2166,
8487 Savannah issue #4361} to see if @command{rcvstore} locking is still an
8488 issue.}.
8489
8490 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
8491 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
8492
8493 Line 16 uses the following script, @code{myrcvstore}, to massage the
8494 message as described in the comment and file the message in the given
8495 folder@footnote{The @samp{-create} argument wasn't always the default
8496 to @command{rcvstore}.}.
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 #! /bin/sh
8500
8501 # Accepts a message on standard input and passes it through rcvstore
8502 # after first passing it through any filters. All arguments are passed
8503 # on to rcvstore.
8504
8505 # Force the "From user date" to become part of header. One reason this
8506 # is done is because the presence of the From field confuses dist so
8507 # that dist adds a new header, rather than using the existing header.
8508 # Note that this should not be done for any message that goes into a
8509 # Gnus incoming file (Gnus will thrown an error) nor should it be
8510 # applied to any message that goes to the system mailbox because the
8511 # entire mailbox will be incorporated as a single message.
8512 formail -c -z -R 'From ' X-Envelope-From: |
8513 rcvstore $@@
8514 @end smallexample
8515
8516 If your version of @command{rcvstore} doesn't add messages to the
8517 @samp{unseen} sequence by default, add the following line to your MH
8518 profile:
8519
8520 @smallexample
8521 Unseen-Sequence: unseen
8522 @end smallexample
8523
8524 Now view your new messages with the speedbar (@pxref{Speedbar}) or with
8525 @kbd{F n} (@code{mh-index-new-messages}). @xref{Folders}.
8526
8527 If you're on a mailing list that is so voluminous that it is
8528 impossible to read every message, it usually better to read the
8529 mailing list like a newsgroup in a news reader. Emacs has a built-in
8530 newsreader called Gnus. The remainder of this appendix talks about how
8531 to use Gnus with an MH message store. The version of Gnus that was
8532 used to prepare this manual was 5.10. Versions 5.8 through 5.10 should
8533 work but versions prior to 5.8 use different options.
8534
8535 This table contains a list of Gnus options that you will have to
8536 modify. Note that for them to become accessible, you'll have to load
8537 @file{nnml.el} first. This can be done with @kbd{M-x load-library
8538 @key{RET} nnml @key{RET}}.
8539
8540 @vtable @code
8541 @item gnus-secondary-select-methods
8542 Select the @samp{nnml} value. This select method uses directories for
8543 folders and individual files for messages, just like MH. You do not
8544 have to set an address.
8545 @c -------------------------
8546 @item mail-sources
8547 Select the @samp{Several files in a directory} value, check the
8548 @samp{Path} box and enter @file{~/Mail} to tell Gnus where to find
8549 your mail.
8550 @c -------------------------
8551 @vindex mail-user-agent
8552 @item message-mail-user-agent
8553 In order to send mail within Gnus using MH-E, set this option to
8554 @samp{mail-user-agent} and set the @code{mail-user-agent} option to
8555 @samp{Emacs interface to MH}.
8556 @c -------------------------
8557 @item nnmail-keep-last-article
8558 Since Gnus keeps track of which messages you have read, it would be
8559 bad if Gnus expired the last message, for example, message 100, and
8560 @command{rcvstore} gave the next new message number 1. Gnus would then
8561 ignore it since it thinks that you've read messages 1-100. Turning on
8562 this option ensures that the last message is never removed thereby
8563 eliminating this problem.
8564 @end vtable
8565
8566 Next add the following to @file{~/.procmailrc}. If you don't subscribe
8567 to the GnuCash mailing list, substitute one to which you are
8568 subscribed.
8569
8570 @smallexample
8571 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
8572 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
8573 # Place mail sent to the GnuCash mailing list in gnucash.spool, where
8574 # Gnus will pick it up.
8575 :0:
8576 * ^TO.*gnucash.*@.*gnucash.org
8577 gnucash.spool
8578 @end smallexample
8579
8580 Wait for some messages to appear in @file{gnucash.spool} and run Gnus
8581 with @kbd{M-x gnus @key{RET}}. To view the folder created in the
8582 example above, you would tell Gnus about it the first time only with
8583 @kbd{G m gnucash @key{RET} nnml @key{RET}}. In MH-E, this folder is
8584 known as @samp{+gnucash}.
8585
8586 @node Odds and Ends, History, Procmail, Top
8587 @appendix Odds and Ends
8588
8589 This appendix covers a few topics that don't fit elsewhere. Here I
8590 tell you how to report bugs and how to get on the MH-E mailing lists.
8591 I also point out some additional sources of information.
8592
8593 @menu
8594 * Bug Reports::
8595 * Mailing Lists::
8596 * MH FAQ and Support::
8597 * Getting MH-E::
8598 @end menu
8599
8600 @node Bug Reports, Mailing Lists, Odds and Ends, Odds and Ends
8601 @appendixsec Bug Reports
8602
8603 @cindex bugs
8604 @cindex SourceForge
8605 @kindex M-x mh-version
8606
8607 Bug reports should be filed at
8608 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/tracker/?group_id=13357&atid=113357,
8609 SourceForge}. You need to be a SourceForge user to submit bug reports,
8610 but this is easy enough to do that it shouldn't be a restriction for
8611 you. Please include the output of @kbd{M-x mh-version}
8612 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}) in any bug report you send unless you're 110%
8613 positive we won't ask for it.
8614
8615 @node Mailing Lists, MH FAQ and Support, Bug Reports, Odds and Ends
8616 @appendixsec MH-E Mailing Lists
8617
8618 @cindex SourceForge
8619 @cindex mailing lists
8620
8621 There are several mailing lists for MH-E. They are @i{mh-e-users at
8622 lists.sourceforge.net}, @i{mh-e-announce at lists.sourceforge.net},
8623 and @i{mh-e-devel at lists.sourceforge.net}. You can subscribe or view
8624 the archives at @uref{https://sourceforge.net/mail/?group_id=13357,
8625 SourceForge}. Do not report bugs on these lists; please submit them
8626 via SourceForge (@pxref{Bug Reports}).
8627
8628 @node MH FAQ and Support, Getting MH-E, Mailing Lists, Odds and Ends
8629 @appendixsec MH FAQ and Support
8630
8631 @cindex FAQ
8632 @cindex MH FAQ
8633
8634 The article @uref{http://www.newt.com/faq/mh.html, @cite{MH Frequently
8635 Asked Questions (FAQ) with Answers}} appears monthly in the newsgroup
8636 @samp{comp.mail.mh}. While very little is there that deals with MH-E
8637 specifically, there is an incredible wealth of material about MH
8638 itself which you will find useful.
8639
8640 @cindex support
8641
8642 You can find FAQs on MH-E at the
8643 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/tracker/?group_id=13357&atid=213357,
8644 Support Requests} page on SourceForge. If you don't find the answer to
8645 your question, file a support request and your question will become a
8646 new FAQ!
8647
8648 @node Getting MH-E, , MH FAQ and Support, Odds and Ends
8649 @appendixsec Getting MH-E
8650
8651 @cindex MH-E, obtaining
8652 @cindex getting MH-E
8653 @cindex obtaining MH-E
8654
8655 Because MH-E is undergoing a phase of sustained growth, the version of
8656 MH-E in your Emacs is likely to be out of date although it is most
8657 likely to be more up to date than the copy that comes with the MH
8658 distribution in @file{miscellany/mh-e}.
8659
8660 @cindex change log
8661 @cindex release notes
8662
8663 New MH-E releases are always available for downloading at
8664 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/project/showfiles.php?group_id=13357,
8665 SourceForge} before they appear in an Emacs release. You can read the
8666 release notes on that page to determine if the given release of MH-E
8667 is already installed in your version of Emacs. You can also read the
8668 change log to see if you are interested in what the given release of
8669 MH-E has to offer (although we have no doubt that you will be
8670 extremely interested in all new releases).
8671
8672 @cindex Debian
8673
8674 If you use Debian, you can install the Debian
8675 @uref{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/mail/mh-e, mh-e package}
8676 instead.
8677
8678 @cindex files, @samp{MH-E-NEWS}
8679 @cindex files, @samp{README}
8680 @cindex news
8681 @cindex @samp{MH-E-NEWS}
8682 @cindex @samp{README}
8683 @kindex M-x mh-version
8684
8685 After you download and extract the MH-E tarball, read the
8686 @file{README} file and @file{MH-E-NEWS}. These correspond to the
8687 release notes and change log mentioned above. The file @file{README}
8688 contains instructions on installing MH-E. If you're already running
8689 Emacs, please quit that session and start again to load in the new
8690 MH-E. Check that you're running the new version with the command
8691 @kbd{M-x mh-version}.
8692
8693 @cindex contributed software
8694 @cindex manual
8695 @cindex documentation
8696
8697 In addition to the mh-e package, the
8698 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/project/showfiles.php?group_id=13357,
8699 SourceForge} site also contains doc and contrib packages. The former
8700 is the latest release of this manual, and the latter contains a few
8701 contributed packages you might find useful.
8702
8703 @node History, GFDL, Odds and Ends, Top
8704 @appendix History of MH-E
8705
8706 @cindex Bill Wohler
8707 @cindex Brian Reid
8708 @cindex Gildea, Stephen
8709 @cindex Jim Larus
8710 @cindex Larus, Jim
8711 @cindex MH-E, versions
8712 @cindex Reid, Brian
8713 @cindex SourceForge
8714 @cindex Stephen Gildea
8715 @cindex Wohler, Bill
8716 @cindex history of MH-E
8717 @cindex versions of MH-E
8718
8719 MH-E was originally written by Brian Reid in 1983 and has changed
8720 hands several times since then. Jim Larus wanted to do something
8721 similar for GNU Emacs, and ended up completely rewriting it that same
8722 year. In 1989, Stephen Gildea picked it up and added many
8723 improvements. Bill Wohler then took over in 2000 and moved its
8724 development to @uref{http://sourceforge.net/, SourceForge} where it
8725 lives today.
8726
8727 @menu
8728 * From Brian Reid::
8729 * From Jim Larus::
8730 * From Stephen Gildea::
8731 * From Bill Wohler::
8732 @end menu
8733
8734 @node From Brian Reid, From Jim Larus, History, History
8735 @appendixsec From Brian Reid
8736
8737 @cindex Brian Reid
8738 @cindex Reid, Brian
8739
8740 One day in 1983 I got the flu and had to stay home from work for three
8741 days with nothing to do. I used that time to write MHE@. The
8742 fundamental idea behind MHE was that it was a ``puppeteer'' driving
8743 the MH programs underneath it. MH had a model that the editor was
8744 supposed to run as a sub-process of the mailer, which seemed to me at
8745 the time to be the tail wagging the dog. So I turned it around and
8746 made the editor drive the MH programs. I made sure that the UCI people
8747 (who were maintaining MH at the time) took in my changes and made them
8748 stick.
8749
8750 Today, I still use my own version of MHE because I don't at all like
8751 the way that GNU MH-E works and I've never gotten to be good enough at
8752 hacking Emacs Lisp to make GNU MH-E do what I want. The Gosling-emacs
8753 version of MHE and the GNU Emacs version of MH-E have almost nothing
8754 in common except similar names. They work differently, have different
8755 conceptual models, and have different key bindings@footnote{After
8756 reading this article, I questioned Brian about his version of MHE, and
8757 received some great ideas for improving MH-E such as a dired-like
8758 method of selecting folders; and removing the prompting when sending
8759 mail, filling in the blanks in the draft buffer instead. I passed them
8760 on to Stephen Gildea, the current maintainer, and he was excited about
8761 the ideas as well. Perhaps one day, MH-E will again resemble MHE
8762 (draft form editing was introduced in version 7.4).}.
8763
8764 Brian Reid, June 1994
8765
8766 @node From Jim Larus, From Stephen Gildea, From Brian Reid, History
8767 @appendixsec From Jim Larus
8768
8769 @cindex Jim Larus
8770 @cindex Larus, Jim
8771
8772 Brian Reid, while at CMU or shortly after going to Stanford wrote a
8773 mail reading program called MHE for Gosling Emacs. It had much the
8774 same structure as MH-E (i.e., invoked MH programs), though it was
8775 simpler and the commands were slightly different. Unfortunately, I no
8776 longer have a copy so the differences are lost in the mists of time.
8777
8778 In '82-83, I was working at BBN and wrote a lot of mlisp code in
8779 Gosling Emacs to make it look more like Tennex Emacs. One of the
8780 packages that I picked up and improved was Reid's mail system. In '83,
8781 I went back to Berkeley. About that time, Stallman's first version of
8782 GNU Emacs came out and people started to move to it from Gosling Emacs
8783 (as I recall, the transition took a year or two). I decided to port
8784 Reid's MHE and used the mlisp to Emacs Lisp translator that came with
8785 GNU Emacs. It did a lousy job and the resulting code didn't work, so I
8786 bit the bullet and rewrote the code by hand (it was a lot smaller and
8787 simpler then, so it took only a day or two).
8788
8789 Soon after that, MH-E became part of the standard Emacs distribution
8790 and suggestions kept dribbling in for improvements. MH-E soon reached
8791 sufficient functionality to keep me happy, but I kept on improving it
8792 because I was a graduate student with plenty of time on my hands and
8793 it was more fun than my dissertation. In retrospect, the one thing
8794 that I regret is not writing any documentation, which seriously
8795 limited the use and appeal of the package.
8796
8797 @cindex @command{xmh}, in MH-E history
8798
8799 In '89, I came to Wisconsin as a professor and decided not to work on
8800 MH-E. It was stable, except for minor bugs, and had enough
8801 functionality, so I let it be for a few years. Stephen Gildea of BBN
8802 began to pester me about the bugs, but I ignored them. In 1990, he
8803 went off to the X Consortium, said good bye, and said that he would
8804 now be using @command{xmh}. A few months later, he came back and said
8805 that he couldn't stand @command{xmh} and could I put a few more bug fixes
8806 into MH-E. At that point, I had no interest in fixing MH-E, so I gave
8807 the responsibility of maintenance to him and he has done a fine job
8808 since then.
8809
8810 Jim Larus, June 1994
8811
8812 @node From Stephen Gildea, From Bill Wohler, From Jim Larus, History
8813 @appendixsec From Stephen Gildea
8814
8815 @cindex Gildea, Stephen
8816 @cindex Stephen Gildea
8817
8818 In 1987 I went to work for Bolt Beranek and Newman, as Jim had before
8819 me. In my previous job, I had been using RMAIL, but as my folders tend
8820 to run large, I was frustrated with the speed of RMAIL@. However, I
8821 stuck with it because I wanted the GNU Emacs interface. I am very
8822 familiar and comfortable with the Emacs interface (with just a few
8823 modifications of my own) and dislike having to use applications with
8824 embedded editors; they never live up to Emacs.
8825
8826 MH is the mail reader of choice at BBN, so I converted to it. Since I
8827 didn't want to give up using an Emacs interface, I started using MH-E.
8828 As is my wont, I started hacking on it almost immediately. I first
8829 used version 3.4m. One of the first features I added was to treat the
8830 folder buffer as a file-visiting buffer: you could lock it, save it,
8831 and be warned of unsaved changes when killing it. I also worked to
8832 bring its functionality a little closer to RMAIL@. Jim Larus was very
8833 cooperative about merging in my changes, and my efforts first appeared
8834 in version 3.6, distributed with Emacs 18.52 in 1988. Next I decided
8835 MH-E was too slow and optimized it a lot. Version, 3.7, distributed
8836 with Emacs 18.56 in 1990, was noticeably faster.
8837
8838 When I moved to the X Consortium I became the first person there to
8839 not use xmh. (There is now one other engineer there using MH-E.) About
8840 this point I took over maintenance of MH-E from Jim and was finally
8841 able to add some features Jim hadn't accepted, such as the backward
8842 searching undo. My first release was 3.8 (Emacs 18.58) in 1992.
8843
8844 Now, in 1994, we see a flurry of releases, with both 4.0 and 5.0.
8845 Version 4.0 added many new features, including background folder
8846 collection and support for composing @sc{mime} messages. (Reading
8847 @sc{mime} messages remains to be done, alas.) While writing this book,
8848 Bill Wohler gave MH-E its closest examination ever, uncovering bugs
8849 and inconsistencies that required a new major version to fix, and so
8850 version 5 was released.
8851
8852 Stephen Gildea, June 1994
8853
8854 @node From Bill Wohler, , From Stephen Gildea, History
8855 @appendixsec From Bill Wohler
8856
8857 @cindex Wohler, Bill
8858 @cindex Bill Wohler
8859
8860 The preface originally included the following text which I use to
8861 begin my story:
8862
8863 @quotation
8864 But it's important to note a brief history of MH-E.
8865
8866 @w{Version 3} was prevalent through the @w{Emacs 18} and early
8867 @w{Emacs 19} years. Then @w{Version 4} came out (@w{Emacs 19.23}),
8868 which introduced several new and changed commands. Next, @w{Version
8869 5.0} was released, which fixed some bugs and incompatibilities, and
8870 was incorporated into @w{Emacs 19.29}.
8871 @end quotation
8872
8873 After a long break, Stephen handed the reins over to me in 2000. I
8874 moved the project to a new site called SourceForge and organized a
8875 great team of developers. Our first release in late 2001 was version
8876 6. It appeared around the time of Emacs 21.2 and had menus and tool
8877 bar buttons.
8878
8879 Then, indexed searches, improved MIME handling, a speedbar, multiple
8880 identities, alias completion, an index view of unseen messages, spam
8881 software support, Face and X-Image-URL header field support, Fcc
8882 completion, arbitrary range handling, and draft form editing were
8883 introduced in the version 7 series around the time of Emacs 21.4
8884 (2004). Still, Emacs itself contained version 5 of MH-E released back
8885 in 1994.
8886
8887 Version 8 development was mostly driven by the rewrite of the manual.
8888 It also brought mailutils support, S/MIME support, picon support, and
8889 an improved interface for hiding header fields. The CVS repository was
8890 migrated from SourceForge to Savannah (only for those files that were
8891 already part of Emacs) and the software was completely reorganized to
8892 push back two decades of entropy. Version 8 will appear in Emacs 22.1,
8893 expected to be released in 2006.
8894
8895 Bill Wohler, February 2006
8896
8897 @node GFDL, GPL, History, Top
8898 @appendix GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE
8899 @center Version 1.2, November 2002
8900
8901 @display
8902 Copyright (C) 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8903 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
8904
8905 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
8906 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
8907 @end display
8908 @sp 1
8909 @enumerate 0
8910 @item
8911 PREAMBLE
8912
8913 The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
8914 functional and useful document ``free'' in the sense of freedom: to
8915 assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
8916 with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
8917 Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
8918 to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
8919 for modifications made by others.
8920
8921 This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
8922 works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
8923 complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
8924 license designed for free software.
8925
8926 We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
8927 software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
8928 program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
8929 software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
8930 it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
8931 whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
8932 principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
8933
8934 @sp 1
8935 @item
8936 APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
8937
8938 This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
8939 contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
8940 distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
8941 world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
8942 work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
8943 refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
8944 licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
8945 copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
8946 under copyright law.
8947
8948 A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
8949 Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
8950 modifications and/or translated into another language.
8951
8952 A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section of
8953 the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
8954 publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject
8955 (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly
8956 within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a
8957 textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
8958 mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
8959 connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
8960 commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
8961 them.
8962
8963 The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
8964 are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
8965 that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
8966 section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
8967 allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
8968 Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
8969 Sections then there are none.
8970
8971 The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
8972 as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
8973 the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
8974 be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
8975
8976 A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
8977 represented in a format whose specification is available to the
8978 general public, that is suitable for revising the document
8979 straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
8980 pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
8981 drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
8982 for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
8983 to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
8984 format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
8985 or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
8986 An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
8987 of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque.''
8988
8989
8990 Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
8991 ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML
8992 or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple
8993 HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of
8994 transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats
8995 include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by
8996 proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
8997 processing tools are not generally available, and the
8998 machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
8999 processors for output purposes only.
9000
9001 The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
9002 plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
9003 this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
9004 formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
9005 the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
9006 preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
9007
9008 A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
9009 title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
9010 text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
9011 specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
9012 ``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
9013 of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
9014 section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
9015
9016 The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
9017 states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
9018 Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
9019 License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
9020 implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
9021 no effect on the meaning of this License.
9022 @sp 1
9023 @item
9024 VERBATIM COPYING
9025
9026 You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
9027 commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
9028 copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
9029 to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
9030 conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
9031 technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
9032 copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
9033 compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
9034 number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
9035
9036 You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
9037 you may publicly display copies.
9038 @sp 1
9039 @item
9040 COPYING IN QUANTITY
9041
9042 If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
9043 printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
9044 Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
9045 copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
9046 Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
9047 the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
9048 you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
9049 the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
9050 visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
9051 Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
9052 the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
9053 as verbatim copying in other respects.
9054
9055 If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
9056 legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
9057 reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
9058 pages.
9059
9060 If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
9061 more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
9062 copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
9063 a computer-network location from which the general network-using
9064 public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
9065 a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
9066 If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
9067 when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
9068 that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
9069 location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
9070 Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
9071 edition to the public.
9072
9073 It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
9074 Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
9075 them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
9076 @sp 1
9077 @item
9078 MODIFICATIONS
9079
9080 You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
9081 the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
9082 the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
9083 Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
9084 and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
9085 of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
9086
9087 A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
9088 from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
9089 (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
9090 of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
9091 if the original publisher of that version gives permission.@*
9092 B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
9093 responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
9094 Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
9095 Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
9096 unless they release you from this requirement.@*
9097 C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
9098 Modified Version, as the publisher.@*
9099 D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.@*
9100 E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
9101 adjacent to the other copyright notices.@*
9102 F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
9103 giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
9104 terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.@*
9105 G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
9106 and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.@*
9107 H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.@*
9108 I. Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
9109 to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
9110 publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
9111 there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
9112 stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
9113 given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
9114 Version as stated in the previous sentence.@*
9115 J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
9116 public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
9117 the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
9118 it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
9119 You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
9120 least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
9121 publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.@*
9122 K. For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'',
9123 Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all
9124 the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements
9125 and/or dedications given therein.@*
9126 L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
9127 unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
9128 or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.@*
9129 M. Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements.'' Such a section
9130 may not be included in the Modified Version.@*
9131 N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements''
9132 or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.@*
9133 O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.@*
9134 @sp 1
9135 If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
9136 appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
9137 copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
9138 of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
9139 list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
9140 These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
9141
9142 You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
9143 nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
9144 parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
9145 been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
9146 standard.
9147
9148 You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
9149 passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
9150 of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
9151 Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
9152 through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
9153 includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
9154 by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
9155 you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
9156 permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
9157
9158 The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
9159 give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
9160 imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
9161 @sp 1
9162 @item
9163 COMBINING DOCUMENTS
9164
9165 You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
9166 License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
9167 versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
9168 Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
9169 list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
9170 license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
9171
9172 The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
9173 multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
9174 copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
9175 different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
9176 adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
9177 author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
9178 Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
9179 Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
9180
9181 In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
9182 in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
9183 ``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
9184 and any sections Entitled ``Dedications.'' You must delete all sections
9185 Entitled ``Endorsements.''
9186 @sp 1
9187 @item
9188 COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
9189
9190 You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
9191 released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
9192 License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
9193 the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
9194 verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
9195
9196 You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
9197 it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
9198 License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
9199 other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
9200 @sp 1
9201 @item
9202 AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
9203
9204 A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
9205 and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
9206 distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
9207 resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
9208 of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
9209 When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
9210 apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
9211 derivative works of the Document.
9212
9213 If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
9214 copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of
9215 the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
9216 covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
9217 electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
9218 Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
9219 aggregate.
9220 @sp 1
9221 @item
9222 TRANSLATION
9223
9224 Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
9225 distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
9226 Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
9227 permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
9228 translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
9229 original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
9230 translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
9231 Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
9232 the original English version of this License and the original versions
9233 of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
9234 the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
9235 or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
9236
9237 If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
9238 ``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve
9239 its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
9240 title.
9241 @sp 1
9242 @item
9243 TERMINATION
9244
9245 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
9246 as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
9247 copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
9248 automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
9249 parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
9250 License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
9251 parties remain in full compliance.
9252 @sp 1
9253 @item
9254 FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
9255
9256 The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
9257 of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
9258 versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
9259 differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
9260 http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
9261
9262 Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
9263 If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
9264 License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
9265 following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
9266 of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
9267 Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
9268 number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
9269 as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
9270
9271 @end enumerate
9272
9273 @unnumberedsec ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
9274
9275 To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
9276 the License in the document and put the following copyright and
9277 license notices just after the title page:
9278
9279 @smallexample
9280 @group
9281 Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{your name}.
9282 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
9283 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2
9284 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
9285 with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
9286 A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
9287 Free Documentation License''.
9288 @end group
9289 @end smallexample
9290
9291 If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
9292 replace the ``with...Texts.'' line with this:
9293
9294 @smallexample
9295 @group
9296 with the Invariant Sections being @var{list their titles}, with the
9297 Front-Cover Texts being @var{list}, and with the Back-Cover Texts being
9298 @var{list}.
9299 @end group
9300 @end smallexample
9301
9302 If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
9303 combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
9304 situation.
9305
9306 If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
9307 recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
9308 free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
9309 to permit their use in free software.
9310
9311 @node GPL, Key Index, GFDL, Top
9312 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
9313 @center Version 2, June 1991
9314
9315 @display
9316 Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9317 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA
9318
9319 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
9320 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
9321 @end display
9322
9323 @unnumberedsec Preamble
9324
9325 The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
9326 freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
9327 License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
9328 software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
9329 General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
9330 Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
9331 using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
9332 the GNU Lesser General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
9333 your programs, too.
9334
9335 When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
9336 price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
9337 have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
9338 this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
9339 if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
9340 in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
9341
9342 To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
9343 anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
9344 These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
9345 distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
9346
9347 For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
9348 gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
9349 you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
9350 source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
9351 rights.
9352
9353 We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
9354 (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
9355 distribute and/or modify the software.
9356
9357 Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
9358 that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
9359 software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
9360 want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
9361 that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
9362 authors' reputations.
9363
9364 Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
9365 patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
9366 program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
9367 program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
9368 patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
9369
9370 The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
9371 modification follow.
9372
9373 @iftex
9374 @unnumberedsec TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
9375 @end iftex
9376 @ifinfo
9377 @center TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
9378 @end ifinfo
9379
9380 @enumerate 0
9381 @item
9382 This License applies to any program or other work which contains
9383 a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
9384 under the terms of this General Public License. The ``Program,'' below,
9385 refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based on the Program''
9386 means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
9387 that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
9388 either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
9389 language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
9390 the term ``modification.'') Each licensee is addressed as ``you.''
9391
9392 Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
9393 covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
9394 running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
9395 is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
9396 Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
9397 Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
9398
9399 @item
9400 You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
9401 source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
9402 conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
9403 copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
9404 notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
9405 and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
9406 along with the Program.
9407
9408 You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
9409 you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
9410
9411 @item
9412 You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
9413 of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
9414 distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
9415 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
9416
9417 @enumerate a
9418 @item
9419 You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
9420 stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
9421
9422 @item
9423 You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
9424 whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
9425 part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
9426 parties under the terms of this License.
9427
9428 @item
9429 If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
9430 when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
9431 interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
9432 announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
9433 notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
9434 a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
9435 these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
9436 License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
9437 does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
9438 the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
9439 @end enumerate
9440
9441 These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
9442 identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
9443 and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
9444 themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
9445 sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
9446 distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
9447 on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
9448 this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
9449 entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
9450
9451 Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
9452 your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
9453 exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
9454 collective works based on the Program.
9455
9456 In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
9457 with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
9458 a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
9459 the scope of this License.
9460
9461 @item
9462 You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
9463 under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
9464 Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
9465
9466 @enumerate a
9467 @item
9468 Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
9469 source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
9470 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
9471
9472 @item
9473 Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
9474 years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
9475 cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
9476 machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
9477 distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
9478 customarily used for software interchange; or,
9479
9480 @item
9481 Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
9482 to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
9483 allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
9484 received the program in object code or executable form with such
9485 an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
9486 @end enumerate
9487
9488 The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
9489 making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
9490 code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
9491 associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
9492 control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
9493 special exception, the source code distributed need not include
9494 anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
9495 form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
9496 operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
9497 itself accompanies the executable.
9498
9499 If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
9500 access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
9501 access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
9502 distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
9503 compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
9504
9505 @item
9506 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
9507 except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
9508 otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
9509 void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
9510 However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
9511 this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
9512 parties remain in full compliance.
9513
9514 @item
9515 You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
9516 signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
9517 distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
9518 prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
9519 modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
9520 Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
9521 all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
9522 the Program or works based on it.
9523
9524 @item
9525 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
9526 Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
9527 original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
9528 these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
9529 restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
9530 You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
9531 this License.
9532
9533 @item
9534 If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
9535 infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
9536 conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
9537 otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
9538 excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
9539 distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
9540 License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
9541 may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
9542 license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
9543 all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
9544 the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
9545 refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
9546
9547 If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
9548 any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
9549 apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
9550 circumstances.
9551
9552 It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
9553 patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
9554 such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
9555 integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
9556 implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
9557 generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
9558 through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
9559 system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
9560 to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
9561 impose that choice.
9562
9563 This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
9564 be a consequence of the rest of this License.
9565
9566 @item
9567 If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
9568 certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
9569 original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
9570 may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
9571 those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
9572 countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
9573 the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9574
9575 @item
9576 The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
9577 of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
9578 be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
9579 address new problems or concerns.
9580
9581 Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
9582 specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and ``any
9583 later version,'' you have the option of following the terms and conditions
9584 either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
9585 Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
9586 this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
9587 Foundation.
9588
9589 @item
9590 If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
9591 programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
9592 to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
9593 Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
9594 make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
9595 of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
9596 of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
9597
9598 @iftex
9599 @heading NO WARRANTY
9600 @end iftex
9601 @ifinfo
9602 @center NO WARRANTY
9603 @end ifinfo
9604
9605 @item
9606 BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
9607 FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW@. EXCEPT WHEN
9608 OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
9609 PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
9610 OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
9611 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE@. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
9612 TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU@. SHOULD THE
9613 PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
9614 REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
9615
9616 @item
9617 IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
9618 WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
9619 REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
9620 INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
9621 OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
9622 TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
9623 YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
9624 PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
9625 POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
9626 @end enumerate
9627
9628 @iftex
9629 @heading END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
9630 @end iftex
9631 @ifinfo
9632 @center END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
9633 @end ifinfo
9634
9635 @page
9636 @unnumberedsec How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
9637
9638 If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
9639 possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
9640 free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
9641
9642 To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
9643 to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
9644 convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
9645 the ``copyright'' line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
9646
9647 @smallexample
9648 @var{one line to give the program's name and an idea of what it does.}
9649 Copyright (C) @var{yyyy} @var{name of author}
9650
9651 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9652 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
9653 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3
9654 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
9655
9656 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
9657 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
9658 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE@. See the
9659 GNU General Public License for more details.
9660
9661 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
9662 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
9663 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
9664 @end smallexample
9665
9666 Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
9667
9668 If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
9669 when it starts in an interactive mode:
9670
9671 @smallexample
9672 Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) @var{yyyy} @var{name of author}
9673 Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details
9674 type `show w'. This is free software, and you are welcome
9675 to redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c'
9676 for details.
9677 @end smallexample
9678
9679 The hypothetical commands @samp{show w} and @samp{show c} should show
9680 the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, the
9681 commands you use may be called something other than @samp{show w} and
9682 @samp{show c}; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items---whatever
9683 suits your program.
9684
9685 You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
9686 school, if any, to sign a ``copyright disclaimer'' for the program, if
9687 necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
9688
9689 @smallexample
9690 @group
9691 Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright
9692 interest in the program `Gnomovision'
9693 (which makes passes at compilers) written
9694 by James Hacker.
9695
9696 @var{signature of Ty Coon}, 1 April 1989
9697 Ty Coon, President of Vice
9698 @end group
9699 @end smallexample
9700
9701 This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
9702 proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
9703 consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
9704 library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
9705 Public License instead of this License.
9706
9707 @node Key Index, Command Index, GPL, Top
9708 @unnumbered Key (Character) Index
9709 @printindex ky
9710
9711 @node Command Index, Option Index, Key Index, Top
9712 @unnumbered Command Index
9713 @printindex fn
9714
9715 @node Option Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
9716 @unnumbered Option (Variable) Index
9717 @printindex vr
9718
9719 @node Concept Index, , Option Index, Top
9720 @unnumbered Concept Index
9721 @printindex cp
9722
9723 @bye
9724
9725 @c Ispell Helpers
9726 @c
9727 @c The following are words that ispell should ignore that would not
9728 @c normally be in a dictionary (global or personal). Be careful not to
9729 @c include words here that could potentially be typos of other words
9730 @c (such as url, elisp, or MHE).
9731 @c
9732 @c LocalWords: CTRL ESC SPC f's
9733 @c LocalWords: addr Aliasfile alist
9734 @c LocalWords: Baushke Bcc BBN Beranek bogofilter bogofilter's
9735 @c LocalWords: cmd CMU contrib cron
9736 @c LocalWords: DesBrisay Dcc devel dir dired docstring filll forw
9737 @c LocalWords: GECOS Gildea Gildea's Ginnean GnuCash goto gnuserv htm
9738 @c LocalWords: ImageMagick inbox ispell keychain
9739 @c LocalWords: Larus licensor LocalWords lookup lpr
9740 @c LocalWords: makeinfo mairix mbox mh mhbuild mhl mhpath mlisp
9741 @c LocalWords: MML msg multipart
9742 @c LocalWords: Namazu NIS nenscript nnml num
9743 @c LocalWords: packmbox passphrase pathname prev procmail prog repl
9744 @c LocalWords: slocal sortm SpamAssassin spammers SpamProbe SpamProbe's
9745 @c LocalWords: sublicense supercite speedbar
9746 @c LocalWords: Tennex texi texinfo Thelen thelenm
9747 @c LocalWords: UCI undeleted whatnow wohler xmh ypcat
9748 @c
9749 @c See http://www.oreilly.com/oreilly/author/stylesheet.html.
9750 @c See http://en.wikipedia.org/.
9751 @c
9752 @c Note the lowercase mh which is needed to avoid hits in the
9753 @c functions and variables. Occasionally, check for accidental
9754 @c inclusion of mh in text by uncommenting the following and executing
9755 @c it with C-x C-e. You want to see "Search failed"
9756 @c (let ((case-fold-search nil))
9757 @c (goto-char (point-min))
9758 @c (search-forward-regexp "^mh\\( \\|$\\)"))
9759 @c
9760 @c An extremely useful setting for texinfo-mode-hook is:
9761 @c (add-to-list
9762 @c 'ispell-skip-region-alist
9763 @c (list
9764 @c (concat "\\(@\\(small\\)?\\(example\\|lisp\\)"
9765 @c "\\(@\\([irw]\\|code\\|var\\){[^}]+}\\|"
9766 @c "@[@{}.]\\|"
9767 @c "[^@]\\|"
9768 @c "@\\(end \\)?group\\|"
9769 @c "@\\(end \\)?cartouche\\)+"
9770 @c "@end \\(small\\)?\\(example\\|lisp\\)\\|"
9771 @c "@\\(code\\|command\\|file\\|kbd\\|sc\\){[^}]+}\\|"
9772 @c "^@end [a-z]+$\\|"
9773 @c "^@\\([fv]\\|print\\)index .*$\\|"
9774 @c "@uref{[^,]+,\\|"
9775 @c "@[a-z]+\\|"
9776 @c "/[a-z.]+[/}]\\)")))))
9777 @c
9778 @c Cross References
9779 @c
9780 @c See existing cross-references to the Emacs manual and the Emacs
9781 @c Lisp manual (search for ``GNU Emacs Manual'' and ``GNU
9782 @c Emacs Lisp Reference Manual'' respectively).
9783
9784 @c @ftable Sorting
9785 @c
9786 @c As per index (sort of): Punctuation, keyboard characters (such as
9787 @c RET and BS) upper and lowercase mixed (lower comes before
9788 @c uppercase), control characters go with uppercase C, meta characters
9789 @c go with uppercase M.
9790 @c In some cases, the sort isn't strictly ASCII.
9791 @c For example, SPC (mh-page-msg) reads better before BS
9792 @c (mh-previous-page) and . (mh-show) is better before ,
9793 @c (mh-header-display).
9794
9795 @c @vtable Sorting
9796 @c
9797 @c Alphabetical, pull hooks into their own table.
9798
9799 @c Local Variables:
9800 @c sentence-end-double-space: nil
9801 @c End:
9802
9803 @ignore
9804 arch-tag: b778477d-1a10-4a99-84de-f877a2ea6bef
9805 @end ignore